blob: 2dab50aac9c891b016510bc411b0e5a1bbc7150c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100490 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100491 - tune.lua.session-timeout
492 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100493 - tune.maxaccept
494 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200495 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200496 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200497 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100498 - tune.rcvbuf.client
499 - tune.rcvbuf.server
500 - tune.sndbuf.client
501 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100502 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100503 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200504 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100505 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200506 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100507 - tune.zlib.memlevel
508 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100509
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510 * Debugging
511 - debug
512 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516------------------------------------
517
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200518ca-base <dir>
519 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200520 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
521 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523chroot <jail dir>
524 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
525 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
526 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
527 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
528 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
529 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100530
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100531cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
532 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
533 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
534 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100535 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
536 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
537 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
538 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
539 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
540 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
541 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
542 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
543 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
544 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100545
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200546crt-base <dir>
547 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
548 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
549 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551daemon
552 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
553 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
554 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
555
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900556external-check
557 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
558 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
559 See "option external-check".
560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561gid <number>
562 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
563 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
564 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100565 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
566 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100568
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569group <group name>
570 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
571 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200573log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
575 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 configured with "log global".
577
578 <address> can be one of:
579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100580 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100581 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
582 port).
583
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100584 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
585 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
586 port).
587
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100588 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
589 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
590 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
591 writeable).
592
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100593 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
594 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
595 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
596 in Bourne shell.
597
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200598 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
599 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
600 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
601 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
602 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
603 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
604 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
605 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
606 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
607 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
608 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
609
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100610 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611
612 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
613 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
614 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
615
616 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200617 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
618 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
619 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
620 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
621 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
622 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200624 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100626log-send-hostname [<string>]
627 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
628 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
629 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
630 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
631 the logs.
632
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633log-tag <string>
634 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
635 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
636 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100637 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000638
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100639lua-load <file>
640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
641 used multiple times.
642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643nbproc <number>
644 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
645 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
646 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
647 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
648 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
649
650pidfile <pidfile>
651 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
652 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
653 starting the process. See also "daemon".
654
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
657 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
658 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
659 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
660 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
661 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100662 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200663 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
664 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100666ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
671 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
672 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
673 "bind" keyword for more information.
674
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100675ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
677 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
678 keyword to see available options.
679
680 Example:
681 global
682 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
683
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100684ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
686 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300687 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100688 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
689 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
690 information.
691
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100692ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
694 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
695 keyword to see available options.
696
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100697ssl-server-verify [none|required]
698 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
699 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
700 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
701
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200702stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
703 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
704 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
705 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
706 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200707
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200708 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
709 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
710 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200711
712stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
713 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
714 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100715 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200716
717stats maxconn <connections>
718 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
719 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721uid <number>
722 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
723 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
724 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
725 one. See also "gid" and "user".
726
727ulimit-n <number>
728 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
729 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
730 option.
731
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100732unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
733 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
734
735 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
736 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
737 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
738 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
739 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
740 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
741 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
742 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
743 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
744 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746user <user name>
747 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
748 See also "uid" and "group".
749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200750node <name>
751 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
752
753 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
754 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
755 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
756 traffic.
757
758description <text>
759 Add a text that describes the instance.
760
761 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
762 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
763 "<" and ">" characters.
764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767-----------------------
768
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200769max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
770 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
771 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
772 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
773 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
774 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
775 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
776 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
777 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
778
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779maxconn <number>
780 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
781 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
782 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200783 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
784 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
785 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
786 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100787 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
788 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
789 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
790 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
791 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200793maxconnrate <number>
794 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
795 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
796 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
797 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
798 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
799 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
800 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
801 fairness.
802
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100803maxcomprate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300805 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100806 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
807 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
808 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
809 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
810 default value.
811
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100812maxcompcpuusage <number>
813 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
814 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
815 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
816 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
817 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
818 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
819 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
820 process down and from introducing high latencies.
821
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100822maxpipes <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
824 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
825 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
826 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
827 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
828 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
829
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200830maxsessrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
832 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
833 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
834 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
835 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
836 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
837 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
838 fairness.
839
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200840maxsslconn <number>
841 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
842 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
843 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
844 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
845 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
846 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
847 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100848 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
849 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
850 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
851 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
852 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
853 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
854 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200855
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200856maxsslrate <number>
857 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
858 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
859 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
860 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
861 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
862 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
863 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
864 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
865 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
866 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
867
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100868maxzlibmem <number>
869 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
870 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
871 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100872 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
873 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
874 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200876noepoll
877 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
878 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100879 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880
881nokqueue
882 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
883 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
884 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
885
886nopoll
887 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
888 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100889 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100890 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100892nosplice
893 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
894 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
895 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100896 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100897 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
898 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
899 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
900 "option splice-response".
901
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300902nogetaddrinfo
903 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
904 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
905
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200906spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900907 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
908 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
909 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
910 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
911 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
912 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200913
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100914tune.buffers.limit <number>
915 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
916 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
917 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
918 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
919 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
920 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
921 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
922 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
923 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
924 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
925 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
926 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
927 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
928 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
929 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
930
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100931tune.buffers.reserve <number>
932 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
933 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
934 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
935 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
936
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200937tune.bufsize <number>
938 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
939 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
940 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
941 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
942 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
943 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
944 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
945 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400946 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
947 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
948 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200949
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200950tune.chksize <number>
951 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
952 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
953 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
954 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
955 checks whenever possible.
956
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100957tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
958 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
959 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
960 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
961 this value. The default value is 1.
962
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100963tune.http.cookielen <number>
964 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
965 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
966 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
967 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
968 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
969 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
970 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
971 to change this value.
972
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200973tune.http.maxhdr <number>
974 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
975 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
976 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
977 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
978 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
979 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
980 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
981 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
982 limit too high.
983
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100984tune.idletimer <timeout>
985 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
986 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
987 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
988 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
989 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
990 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
991 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
992 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
993 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
994
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100995tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
996 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
997 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
998 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
999 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1000 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1001 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1002 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1003
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001004tune.lua.maxmem
1005 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1006 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1007 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1008 memory.
1009
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001010tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1011 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1012 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1013 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1014 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1015 4s.
1016
1017tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1018 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1019 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1020 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1021 check servers.
1022
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001023tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001024 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1025 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1026 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1027 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1028 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1029 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1030 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1031 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1032 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1033 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001034
1035tune.maxpollevents <number>
1036 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1037 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1038 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1039 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1040 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1041
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001042tune.maxrewrite <number>
1043 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1044 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1045 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1046 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1047 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1048 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1049 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1050 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1051 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1052 bufsize.
1053
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001054tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1055 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1056 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1057 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1058 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1059 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1060 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1061 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1062 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1063 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1064 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1065 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1066 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1067 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1068 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1069 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1070 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1071 setting this parameter to 0.
1072
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001073tune.pipesize <number>
1074 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1075 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1076 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1077 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1078 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1079 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1080
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001081tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1082tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1083 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1084 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1085 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1086 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1087 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1088 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1089 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1090
1091tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1092tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1093 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1094 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1095 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1096 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1097 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1098 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1099 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1100 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1101 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1102 notifying haproxy again.
1103
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001104tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001105 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1106 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1107 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001108 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001109 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1110 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1111 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1112 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1113 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001114 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1115 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001116
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001117tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1118 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1119 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1120 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1121 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1122 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1123 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1124
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001125tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1126 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001127 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001128 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1129 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1130 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1131 being used for too long.
1132
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001133tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1134 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1135 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1136 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1137 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1138 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1139 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1140 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1141 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1142 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1143 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001144 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1145 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001146
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001147tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1148 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1149 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1150 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1151 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1152 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1153 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1154 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1155 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1156
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001157tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1158 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001160 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1161 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1162 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1163
1164tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1165 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1166 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1167 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1168 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703.3. Debugging
1171--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
1173debug
1174 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1175 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1176 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1177 system startup.
1178
1179quiet
1180 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1181 line argument "-q".
1182
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011843.4. Userlists
1185--------------
1186It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1187http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1188it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1189
1190userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001191 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001192 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1193
1194group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001195 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001196 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1197 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001199user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1200 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001201 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1202 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001203 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1204 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001205 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001206 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001207
1208
1209 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001210 userlist L1
1211 group G1 users tiger,scott
1212 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001213
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001214 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1215 user scott insecure-password elgato
1216 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001218 userlist L2
1219 group G1
1220 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001221
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001222 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1223 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1224 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001225
1226 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001227
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001228
12293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001230----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001231It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1232haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1233pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1234identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1235or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1236Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1237known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1238the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1239process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1240during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1241tables.
1242
1243peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001244 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001245 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1246
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001247disabled
1248 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1249 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1250 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1251
1252enable
1253 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001255peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1256 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1257 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1258 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1259 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1260 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1261 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1262
1263 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1264 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1265
1266 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1267 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1268 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1269 across all peers.
1270
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001271 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1272 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1273 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1274
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001275 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001276 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001277 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1278 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1279 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001280
1281 backend mybackend
1282 mode tcp
1283 balance roundrobin
1284 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1285 stick on src
1286
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001287 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1288 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001289
1290
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012913.6. Mailers
1292------------
1293It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1294If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1295in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1296
1297mailer <mailersect>
1298 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1299 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1300
1301mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1302 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1303
1304 Example:
1305 mailers mymailers
1306 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1307 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1308
1309 backend mybackend
1310 mode tcp
1311 balance roundrobin
1312
1313 email-alert mailers mymailers
1314 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1315 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1316
1317 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1318 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1319
1320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1325 - defaults <name>
1326 - frontend <name>
1327 - backend <name>
1328 - listen <name>
1329
1330A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1331its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1332section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001333section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1336connections.
1337
1338A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1339to forward incoming connections.
1340
1341A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1342parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1345'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1346case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1347
1348Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1349logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1350proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1351However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1352name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1353
1354Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1355and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001356bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1358modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1359arbitrary criteria.
1360
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001361In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1362a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1363the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1364
1365 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1366 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1367 between responses and new requests.
1368
1369 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1370 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1371 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1372 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1373
1374 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1375 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1376 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1377
1378 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1379 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1380 client-facing connection remains open.
1381
1382 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1383 after the end of the response.
1384
1385The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1386frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1387following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1388weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1389
1390 Backend mode
1391
1392 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1393 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1394 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1395 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1396 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1397 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1398 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1399 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1400 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1401 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1402 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1407--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001409The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1410limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1411they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1412limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001414option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001415and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1416with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1417specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001420 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1421------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1422acl - X X X
1423appsession - - X X
1424backlog X X X -
1425balance X - X X
1426bind - X X -
1427bind-process X X X X
1428block - X X X
1429capture cookie - X X -
1430capture request header - X X -
1431capture response header - X X -
1432clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001433compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1435cookie X - X X
1436default-server X - X X
1437default_backend X X X -
1438description - X X X
1439disabled X X X X
1440dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001441email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001442email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001443email-alert mailers X X X X
1444email-alert myhostname X X X X
1445email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001446enabled X X X X
1447errorfile X X X X
1448errorloc X X X X
1449errorloc302 X X X X
1450-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1451errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001452force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453fullconn X - X X
1454grace X X X X
1455hash-type X - X X
1456http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001457http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001458http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001460http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001461http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001463ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001464log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001465log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001466log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001467max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468maxconn X X X -
1469mode X X X X
1470monitor fail - X X -
1471monitor-net X X X -
1472monitor-uri X X X -
1473option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1474option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1475option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1476option allbackups (*) X - X X
1477option checkcache (*) X - X X
1478option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1479option contstats (*) X X X -
1480option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1481option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1482option forceclose (*) X X X X
1483-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1484option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001485option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001486option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001487option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001488option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001489option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001490option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001491option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1492option httpchk X - X X
1493option httpclose (*) X X X X
1494option httplog X X X X
1495option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001496option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001497option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001498option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001499option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1500option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1501option logasap (*) X X X -
1502option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001503option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001504option nolinger (*) X X X X
1505option originalto X X X X
1506option persist (*) X - X X
1507option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001508option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001509option smtpchk X - X X
1510option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1511option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1512option splice-request (*) X X X X
1513option splice-response (*) X X X X
1514option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1515option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1516-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001517option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001518option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1519option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1520option tcpka X X X X
1521option tcplog X X X X
1522option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001523external-check command X - X X
1524external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001525persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1526rate-limit sessions X X X -
1527redirect - X X X
1528redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1529redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1530reqadd - X X X
1531reqallow - X X X
1532reqdel - X X X
1533reqdeny - X X X
1534reqiallow - X X X
1535reqidel - X X X
1536reqideny - X X X
1537reqipass - X X X
1538reqirep - X X X
1539reqisetbe - X X X
1540reqitarpit - X X X
1541reqpass - X X X
1542reqrep - X X X
1543-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1544reqsetbe - X X X
1545reqtarpit - X X X
1546retries X - X X
1547rspadd - X X X
1548rspdel - X X X
1549rspdeny - X X X
1550rspidel - X X X
1551rspideny - X X X
1552rspirep - X X X
1553rsprep - X X X
1554server - - X X
1555source X - X X
1556srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001557stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001558stats auth X - X X
1559stats enable X - X X
1560stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001561stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001562stats realm X - X X
1563stats refresh X - X X
1564stats scope X - X X
1565stats show-desc X - X X
1566stats show-legends X - X X
1567stats show-node X - X X
1568stats uri X - X X
1569-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1570stick match - - X X
1571stick on - - X X
1572stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001573stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001574stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001575tcp-check connect - - X X
1576tcp-check expect - - X X
1577tcp-check send - - X X
1578tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001579tcp-request connection - X X -
1580tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001581tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001582tcp-response content - - X X
1583tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001584timeout check X - X X
1585timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001586timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001587timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1588timeout connect X - X X
1589timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1590timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1591timeout http-request X X X X
1592timeout queue X - X X
1593timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001594timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001595timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1596timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001597timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001598transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001599unique-id-format X X X -
1600unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001601use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001602use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1604 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016074.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1608---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001609
1610This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1611
1612
1613acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1614 Declare or complete an access list.
1615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1616 no | yes | yes | yes
1617 Example:
1618 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1619 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1620 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001622 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001623
1624
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001625appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1626 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1629 no | no | yes | yes
1630 Arguments :
1631 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1632 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1633
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001634 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001635 checked in each cookie value.
1636
1637 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1638 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1639 milliseconds.
1640
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001641 request-learn
1642 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1643 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1644 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1645 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1646 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1647 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1648
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001649 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1650 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1651 data following this prefix.
1652
1653 Example :
1654 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1655
1656 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1657 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1658
1659 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1660 2 modes are currently supported :
1661 - path-parameters :
1662 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1663 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1664 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1665 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1666 - query-string :
1667 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1668 query string.
1669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1671 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1672 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1673 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001674 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1675 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1676 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1678 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1679
1680 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1681
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001682 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1683 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1684 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686 Example :
1687 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1688
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001689 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1690 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
1692
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001693backlog <conns>
1694 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1696 yes | yes | yes | no
1697 Arguments :
1698 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1699 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001700 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001701
1702 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1703 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1704 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1705 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1706 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1707 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1708 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1709 backlog parameter.
1710
1711 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1712 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1713 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1714
1715 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1716
1717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001719balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1722 yes | no | yes | yes
1723 Arguments :
1724 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1725 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1726 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1727 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1728
1729 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1730 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1731 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1732 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001733 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001734 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001735 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1736 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1737 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1738 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1739 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1740 it, so that you don't worry.
1741
1742 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1743 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1744 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1745 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1746 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1747 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1748 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1749 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001750
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001751 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1752 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1753 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1754 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1755 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1756 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1757 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1758 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1759
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001760 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001761 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001762 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1763 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001764 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001765 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1766 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1767 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1768 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1769 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001770 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1771 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1772 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1773 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1774 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1775 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001777 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1778 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1779 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1780 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1781 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1782 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1783 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1784 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001785 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1788 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1789 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001791 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1792 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1793 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1794 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1795 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1796 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1797 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1798 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1799 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1800 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1801 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1802 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001804 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001805 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1806 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1807 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1808 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1809 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1810 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1811 URIs start with a leading "/".
1812
1813 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1814 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1815 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1816 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001819 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1820
1821 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001822 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1823 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001824 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1825 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1826 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1827 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001828 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001829 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1830 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001831
1832 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1833 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1834 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1835 server will receive the request.
1836
1837 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1838 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1839 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1840 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1841 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001842 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1843 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1844 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001846 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1847 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1848 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1849 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1850 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001852 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001853 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1854 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1855 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1856
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001857 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1858 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1859 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1860
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001861 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001862 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001863 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1864 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1865 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1866 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1867 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1868 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001869 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001870 used instead.
1871
1872 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1873 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1874 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1875 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1876
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001877 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1878 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1879 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1880
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001881 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001884 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1885 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001886
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001887 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1888 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1889 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890
1891 Examples :
1892 balance roundrobin
1893 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001894 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001895 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1896 balance hdr(host)
1897 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001898
1899 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1900 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001902 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001903 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1904 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1905 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1906 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1907
1908 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1909 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1910 defaults to 16 kB.
1911
1912 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1913 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1914
1915 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1916 Round Robin.
1917
1918 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1919 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1920 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1921 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1922
1923 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1924
1925 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001926 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001927 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1928 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1929 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001931 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1932 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001933
1934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001935bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1936bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1939 no | yes | yes | no
1940 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001941 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1942 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1943 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1944 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001945 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001946 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1947 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1948 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1949 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1950 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1951 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1952 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001953 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1954 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1955 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1956 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1957 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1958 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1959 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001960 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1961 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1962 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001963 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1964 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1965 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1966 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001967
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001968 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1969 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001970 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1971 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1972 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001973 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1974 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1975 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1976 the range.
1977
1978 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1979 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1980 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1981 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1982 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1983 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1984 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001985 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001986 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001988 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1989 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1990 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1991 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1992 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1993 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1994 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1995 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001997 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1998 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1999 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2000 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2003 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2004 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2005 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2006 in a frontend.
2007
2008 Example :
2009 listen http_proxy
2010 bind :80,:443
2011 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002012 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002014 listen http_https_proxy
2015 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002016 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002017
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002018 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2019 bind ipv6@:80
2020 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2021 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2022
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002023 listen external_bind_app1
2024 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
2025
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002026 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002027 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
2029
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002030bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002031 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2033 yes | yes | yes | yes
2034 Arguments :
2035 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2036 may be used to override a default value.
2037
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002038 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002039 option may be combined with other numbers.
2040
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002041 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002042 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2043 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2044 missing from all processes.
2045
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002046 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002047 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002048 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2049 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2050 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2051 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002052
2053 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2054 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2055 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2056 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2057 and 'even' instances.
2058
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002059 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2060 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2061 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2062 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002063
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002064 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2065 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2066
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002067 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2068 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2069 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2070
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002071 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2072 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2073
2074 Example :
2075 listen app_ip1
2076 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002077 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002078
2079 listen app_ip2
2080 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002081 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002082
2083 listen management
2084 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002085 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002086
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002087 listen management
2088 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2089 bind-process 1-4
2090
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002091 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002092
2093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094block { if | unless } <condition>
2095 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2097 no | yes | yes | yes
2098
2099 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2100 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002101 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002102 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2104 "block" statements per instance.
2105
2106 Example:
2107 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2108 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2109 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2110 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
2114
2115capture cookie <name> len <length>
2116 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 no | yes | yes | no
2119 Arguments :
2120 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2121 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2122 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2123 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2124 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2125
2126 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2127 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2128 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2129 right if it exceeds <length>.
2130
2131 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2132 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2133 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2134 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2135
2136 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2137 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2138 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2139
2140 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2141 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2142 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002143 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2144 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2145 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
2147 Example:
2148 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2149
2150 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002151 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152
2153
2154capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002155 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2157 no | yes | yes | no
2158 Arguments :
2159 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002160 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2162 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2163 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2164
2165 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2166 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2167 it exceeds <length>.
2168
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002169 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2171 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002172 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2173 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2174 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2175 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002176 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002177 environments to find where the request came from.
2178
2179 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2180 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2181 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2182 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002184 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2185 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2186 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2187 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2188 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189
2190 Example:
2191 capture request header Host len 15
2192 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2193 capture request header Referrer len 15
2194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002195 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002196 about logging.
2197
2198
2199capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002200 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 no | yes | yes | no
2203 Arguments :
2204 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002205 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2207 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2208 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2209
2210 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2211 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2212 it exceeds <length>.
2213
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002214 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2216 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2217 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002218 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2219 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2220 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2221 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002223 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2224 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2225 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2226 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2227 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
2229 Example:
2230 capture response header Content-length len 9
2231 capture response header Location len 15
2232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002233 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 about logging.
2235
2236
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002238 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2240 yes | yes | yes | no
2241 Arguments :
2242 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2243 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2244 as explained at the top of this document.
2245
2246 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2247 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2248 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2249 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2250 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2251 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2252 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2253 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002254 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2256 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2257
2258 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2260 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2261 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2262 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2263 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2264
2265 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2266 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2267
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002268 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2269 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002271compression algo <algorithm> ...
2272compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002273compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002274 Enable HTTP compression.
2275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2276 yes | yes | yes | yes
2277 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002278 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2279 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2280 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2281
2282 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002283 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2284 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2285 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002286
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002287 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2288 support for zlib was built in.
2289
2290 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2291 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2292 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2293 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2294 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2295 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002296
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002297 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2298 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2299 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2300 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2301 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2302 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2303 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2304 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002305
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002306 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002307 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002308 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2309 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2310 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2311 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2312 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002313
2314 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2315 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2316 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2317 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2318 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002319 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2320 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2321 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2322 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2323 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002324 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2325 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002326
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002327 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002328 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2329 "Accept-Encoding" header
2330 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002331 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002332 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2333 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002334 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2335 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2336 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2337 "multipart"
2338 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2339 header
2340 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2341 and later
2342 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2343 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002344
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002345 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2346 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002347
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002348 Examples :
2349 compression algo gzip
2350 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002352contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2355 yes | no | yes | yes
2356 Arguments :
2357 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2359 as explained at the top of this document.
2360
2361 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002362 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002363 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2365 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2366 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2367 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2368
2369 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2370 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2371 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2372 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2373 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2374 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2375
2376 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2377 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2378 instead.
2379
2380 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2381 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2382
2383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002384cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002385 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2386 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2389 yes | no | yes | yes
2390 Arguments :
2391 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2392 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2393 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2394 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2395 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2396 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2397 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2398 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2399 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2400
2401 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2402 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2403 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2404 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2405 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2406 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2407 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2408 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2409 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2410 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2411 "insert" and "prefix".
2412
2413 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002414 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002415
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002416 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002417 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2418 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2419 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2420 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2421 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2422 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2423 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2424 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2425 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2426 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427
2428 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2429 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2430 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2431 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2432 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2433 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2434 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2435 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2436 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2437 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002438 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2439 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2440 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002441
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002442 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2443 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2444 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002445 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2446 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2447 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2448 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002449 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2450 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2451 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002452
2453 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2454 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2455 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2456 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2457 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2458 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2459 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2460 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2461 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2462
2463 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2464 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2465 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2466 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2467 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2468 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2469 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2470 persistence cookie in the cache.
2471 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2472
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002473 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2474 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2475 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2476 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2477 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2478 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2479 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2480 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2481 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2482 they logout.
2483
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002484 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2485 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2486 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2487 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2488
2489 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2490 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2491 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2492 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2493 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2494 this attribute.
2495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002496 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002497 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002498 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2499 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2500 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2501 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2502 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2503 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002504
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002505 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2506 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2507 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2508 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2509 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2510 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2511 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2512 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2513 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2514 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2515 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2516 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2517 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2518 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2519 the site.
2520
2521 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2522 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2523 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2524 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2525 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2526 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2527 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2528 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2529 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2530 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2531 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2532 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2533 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2534 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2535 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2536 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2539 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2540 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2541 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 Examples :
2544 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2545 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2546 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002547 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002549 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002550 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002553default-server [param*]
2554 Change default options for a server in a backend
2555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2556 yes | no | yes | yes
2557 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002558 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2559 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2560 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2561 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002562
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002563 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002564 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2565
2566 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569default_backend <backend>
2570 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2572 yes | yes | yes | no
2573 Arguments :
2574 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2575
2576 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2577 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2578 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2579 will catch all undetermined requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581 Example :
2582
2583 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2584 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2585 default_backend dynamic
2586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002587 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002590description <string>
2591 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2593 no | yes | yes | yes
2594 Arguments : string
2595
2596 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2597 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2598 it describes.
2599 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2600
2601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602disabled
2603 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 yes | yes | yes | yes
2606 Arguments : none
2607
2608 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2609 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2610 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2611 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2612 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2613 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2614 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2615
2616 See also : "enabled"
2617
2618
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002619dispatch <address>:<port>
2620 Set a default server address
2621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2622 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002624
2625 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2626 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2627 during start-up.
2628
2629 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2630 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2631 possible with normal servers.
2632
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002633 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002634 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2635 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2636 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2637 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2638
2639 See also : "server"
2640
2641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642enabled
2643 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2645 yes | yes | yes | yes
2646 Arguments : none
2647
2648 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2649 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2650
2651 See also : "disabled"
2652
2653
2654errorfile <code> <file>
2655 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2657 yes | yes | yes | yes
2658 Arguments :
2659 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002660 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2661 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
2663 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002664 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002666 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2667 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668
2669 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2670 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2671 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2672
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002673 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2676 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2677 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2678 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2679
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002680 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2681 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2682 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2683 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2684 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2685 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2688 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2689 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002690 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2692
2693 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2694
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002695 Example :
2696 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002697 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002698 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2699 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701
2702errorloc <code> <url>
2703errorloc302 <code> <url>
2704 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | yes
2707 Arguments :
2708 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002709 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002710
2711 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2712 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2713 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2714 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2715 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2716
2717 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2718 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2719 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2720
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002721 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002723 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2724 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2725 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2726 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2727 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2728 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2729 request.
2730
2731 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2732
2733
2734errorloc303 <code> <url>
2735 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2737 yes | yes | yes | yes
2738 Arguments :
2739 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2740 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2741
2742 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2743 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2744 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2745 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2746 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2747
2748 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2749 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2750 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2751
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002752 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002754 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2755 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2756 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2757 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002758 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002759
2760 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2761
2762
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002763email-alert from <emailaddr>
2764 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2765 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 yes | yes | yes | yes
2768
2769 Arguments :
2770
2771 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2772
2773 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2774 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2775
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002776 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2777 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2778
2779
2780email-alert level <level>
2781 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2782 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2784 yes | yes | yes | yes
2785
2786 Arguments :
2787
2788 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2789 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2790 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2791
2792 By default level is alert
2793
2794 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2795 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2796 for the proxy.
2797
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002798 Alerts are sent when :
2799
2800 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2801 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2802 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2803 is notice or lower
2804 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2805 and a health check status update occurs
2806
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002807 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2808 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002809 section 3.6 about mailers.
2810
2811
2812email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2813 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2815 yes | yes | yes | yes
2816
2817 Arguments :
2818
2819 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2820
2821 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2822 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2823
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002824 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2825 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002826
2827
2828email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2829 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2830 mailers.
2831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2832 yes | yes | yes | yes
2833
2834 Arguments :
2835
2836 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2837
2838 By default the systems hostname is used.
2839
2840 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2841 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2842 for the proxy.
2843
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002844 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2845 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002846
2847
2848email-alert to <emailaddr>
2849 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2850 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2852 yes | yes | yes | yes
2853
2854 Arguments :
2855
2856 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2857
2858 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2859 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2860
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002861 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002862 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2863
2864
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002865force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2866 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2868 no | yes | yes | yes
2869
2870 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2871 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2872 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2873 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2874 marked down for maintenance operations.
2875
2876 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2877 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2878 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2879 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2880 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2881 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2882 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2883 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2884 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2885
2886 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2887 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2888 is used.
2889
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002890 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002891 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002892
2893
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002894fullconn <conns>
2895 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2897 yes | no | yes | yes
2898 Arguments :
2899 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2900 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2901
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002902 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002903 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002904 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002905 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2906 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2907 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2908 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2909 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002910 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002911
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002912 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2913 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002914 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2915 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2916 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002917
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002918 Example :
2919 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2920 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2921 # connections.
2922 backend dynamic
2923 fullconn 10000
2924 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2925 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2926
2927 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2928
2929
2930grace <time>
2931 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002933 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002934 Arguments :
2935 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2936 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2937 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2938
2939 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2940 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002941 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002942 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2943
2944 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2945 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2946 simplify it.
2947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002949hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002950 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2952 yes | no | yes | yes
2953 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002954 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2955 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002956
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002957 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2958 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2959 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2960 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2961 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2962 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2963 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2964 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2965 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2966 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002967
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002968 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2969 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2970 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2971 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2972 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2973 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2974 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2975 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2976 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2977 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2978 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2979 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2980 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002981 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2982 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002983
2984 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2985
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002986 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002987 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2988 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2989 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002990 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2991 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2992 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002993
2994 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2995 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002996 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2997 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2998 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2999 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3000
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003001 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3002 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3003 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3004 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3005 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3006 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3007 parameter.
3008
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003009 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3010 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3011 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3012 used on strings.
3013
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003014 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3015
3016 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3017 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3018 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3019 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3020 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3021 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3022 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3023 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3024 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3025 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3026 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3027 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003028
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003029 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3030 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3031 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003032
3033 See also : "balance", "server"
3034
3035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036http-check disable-on-404
3037 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040 Arguments : none
3041
3042 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3043 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3044 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3045 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3046 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3047 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3048 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3049 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003050 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3051 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3052 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3053
3054 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3055
3056
3057http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003058 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003060 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003061 Arguments :
3062 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3063 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003064 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003065 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3066 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3067 details on the supported keywords.
3068
3069 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3070 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3071 with the usual backslash ('\').
3072
3073 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3074 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3075 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3076 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3077 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3078
3079 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003080 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003081 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3082 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3083 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3084
3085 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003086 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003087 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3088 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3089 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3090 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3091
3092 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003093 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003094 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3095 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3096 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3097 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3098 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3099 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3100 trace).
3101
3102 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003103 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003104 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3105 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3106 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3107 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3108 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3109 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3110
3111 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3112 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3113 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3114 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3115 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3116 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3117 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3118 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3119
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003120 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3121 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3122 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3123
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003124 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3125 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3126
3127 Examples :
3128 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003129 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003130
3131 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003132 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003133
3134 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003135 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003136
3137 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003138 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003140 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003141
3142
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003143http-check send-state
3144 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | no | yes | yes
3147 Arguments : none
3148
3149 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3150 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3151 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3152 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3153 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3154
3155 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3156 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3157 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3158 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3159 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003160 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3161 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3162 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3163
3164 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3165 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3166 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3167
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003168 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3169 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3170 checked in multiple backends.
3171
3172 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3173 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3174
3175 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3176 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3177 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3178 one fails.
3179
3180 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3181 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3182 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3183
3184 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3185 server's queue.
3186
3187 Example of a header received by the application server :
3188 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3189 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3190
3191 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3192
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003193http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003194 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003195 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003196 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3197 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003198 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3199 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003200 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3201 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3202 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003203 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003204 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3205 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003206 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003207 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003208 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3209
3210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 no | yes | yes | yes
3212
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003213 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3214 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3215 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3216 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3217 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003218
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003219 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3220 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3221 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3222
3223 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3224 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3225 are evaluated.
3226
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003227 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3228 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3229 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3230 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3231 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3232 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3233 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3234 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3235 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003236 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003237 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3238
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003239 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3240 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3241 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3242 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3243 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3244
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003245 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3246 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3247 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003248 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3249 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003250
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003251 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3252 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3253 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3254 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3255 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3256 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3257 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3258 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3259
3260 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3261 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3262 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003263 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3264 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003265
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003266 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3267 <name>.
3268
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003269 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3270 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3271 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3272 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3273 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3274 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3275 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3276 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3277
3278 Example:
3279
3280 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3281
3282 applied to:
3283
3284 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3285
3286 outputs:
3287
3288 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3289
3290 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3291
3292 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3293 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3294 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3295 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3296 header.
3297
3298 Example:
3299
3300 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3301
3302 applied to:
3303
3304 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3305
3306 outputs:
3307
3308 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3309
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003310 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3311 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3312 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3313 it.
3314
3315 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3316 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3317 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3318 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3319 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3320 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3321
3322 Example :
3323 # prepend the host name before the path
3324 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3325
3326 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3327 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3328 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3329 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3330 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3331 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3332 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3333 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3334
3335 Example :
3336 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3337 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3338
3339 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3340 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3341 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3342 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3343 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3344 "set-query".
3345
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003346 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3347 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3348 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3349 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3350 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3351 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3352 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3353 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3354
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003355 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3356 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3357 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3358 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3359 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3360 another equipment.
3361
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003362 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3363 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3364 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3365 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3366 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3367 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3368 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3369 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3370
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003371 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3372 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3373 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3374 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3375 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3376 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3377 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3378 admin privileges.
3379
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003380 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3381 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3382 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3383 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3384 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3385 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3386 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3387 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3388
3389 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3390 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3391 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3392 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3393 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3394 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3395
3396 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3397 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3398 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3399 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3400 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3401 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3402
3403 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3404 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3405 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3406 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3407 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3408 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3409 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3410 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3411 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3412
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003413 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3414 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3415 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3416 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3417 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3418 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3419 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3420 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3421 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3422 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3423 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3424 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3425
3426 These actions take one or two arguments :
3427 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3428 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3429 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3430 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3431
3432 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3433 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3434 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3435 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3436
3437 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3438 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3439 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3440 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3441 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3442 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3443 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3444 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3445
3446 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3447 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3448 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3449 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3450 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3451
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003452 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3453 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3454 function is documented in the API documentation.
3455
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003456 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3457
3458 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3459 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3460 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3461 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003462
3463 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003464 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3465 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3466 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003467
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003468 http-request allow if nagios
3469 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3470 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3471 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003472
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003473 Example:
3474 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003475 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003476
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003477 Example:
3478 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3479 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3480 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3481 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3482 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3483 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3484 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3485 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3486 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3487
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003488 Example:
3489 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3490 acl add path /addacl
3491 acl del path /delacl
3492
3493 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3494
3495 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3496 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3497
3498 Example:
3499 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3500 acl setmap path /setmap
3501 acl delmap path /delmap
3502
3503 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3504
3505 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3506 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3507
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003508 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3509 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003510
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003511http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003512 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003513 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3514 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003515 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3516 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3517 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3518 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003519 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3520 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003521 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003523 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3524
3525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 no | yes | yes | yes
3527
3528 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3529 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3530 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3531 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3532 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3533 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3534
3535 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3536 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3537 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3538 current section.
3539
3540 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3541 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3542 rules are evaluated.
3543
3544 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3545 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3546 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3547 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3548 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3549 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3550 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3551
3552 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3553 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3554 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3555 external users.
3556
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003557 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3558 <name>.
3559
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003560 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3561 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3562 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3563 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3564 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3565 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3566 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3567 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3568
3569 Example:
3570
3571 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3572
3573 applied to:
3574
3575 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3576
3577 outputs:
3578
3579 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3580
3581 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3582
3583 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3584 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3585 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3586 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3587 header.
3588
3589 Example:
3590
3591 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3592
3593 applied to:
3594
3595 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3596
3597 outputs:
3598
3599 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3600
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003601 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3602 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3603 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3604 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3605 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3606 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3607 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3608 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3609
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003610 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3611 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3612 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3613 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3614 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3615 another equipment.
3616
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003617 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3618 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3619 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3620 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3621 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3622 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3623 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3624 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3625
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003626 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3627 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3628 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3629 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3630 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3631 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3632 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3633 admin privileges.
3634
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003635 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3636 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3637 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3638 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3639 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3640 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3641 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3642 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3643
3644 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3645 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3646 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3647 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3648 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3649 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3650
3651 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3652 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3653 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3654 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3655 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3656 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3657
3658 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3659 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3660 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3661 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3662 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3663 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3664 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3665 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3666 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3667
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003668 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3669 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3670 function is documented in the API documentation.
3671
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003672 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3673
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003674 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003675 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3676 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3677 rules.
3678
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003679 Example:
3680 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3681
3682 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3683
3684 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3685 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3686
3687 Example:
3688 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3689
3690 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3691
3692 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3693 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3694
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003695 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3696 ACL usage.
3697
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003698
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003699http-send-name-header [<header>]
3700 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3701
3702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3703 yes | no | yes | yes
3704
3705 Arguments :
3706
3707 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3708
3709 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3710 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3711 is added with the header string proved.
3712
3713 See also : "server"
3714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003715id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003716 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 no | yes | yes | yes
3719 Arguments : none
3720
3721 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3722 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3723 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003724
3725
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003726ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3727 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 no | yes | yes | yes
3730
3731 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3732 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3733 and running).
3734
3735 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3736 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3737 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003738 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003739 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3740
3741 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3742 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3743
3744 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3745 "unless" condition is met.
3746
3747 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3748
3749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003751log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003752no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003753 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3755 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003756
3757 Prefix :
3758 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3759 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3760 prefix does not allow arguments.
3761
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003762 Arguments :
3763 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3764 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3765 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3766 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3767 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3768 parameter.
3769
3770 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3771 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3772
3773 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3774 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3775 standard syslog port).
3776
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003777 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3778 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3779 standard syslog port).
3780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003781 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3782 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3783 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3784 appropriately writeable).
3785
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003786 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3787 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3788 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3789 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3790
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003791 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3792 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3793 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3794 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3795 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3796 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3797 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3798 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3799 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3800 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3801 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003803 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3804
3805 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3806 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3807 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3808
3809 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3810 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3811 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003812 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3813 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3814 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3815 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3816 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003817
3818 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3819
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003820 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3821 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3822 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003823
3824 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3825 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3826 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3827 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3828
3829 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3830 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003831
3832 Example :
3833 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003834 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3835 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003836 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003838
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003839log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003840 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3841 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3842 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003843
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003844 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3845 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3846 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3847 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3848 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003849
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003850log-tag <string>
3851 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854
3855 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3856 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3857 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3858 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3859 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3860 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3861 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3862 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3863 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003865max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3866 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | no | yes | yes
3869
3870 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3871 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3872 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3873 servers.
3874
3875 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3876 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3877 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3878 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3879 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3880 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3881 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3882 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3883 picking a different server.
3884
3885 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3886 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3887 even if they have to be queued.
3888
3889 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3890 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3891
3892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003893maxconn <conns>
3894 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3896 yes | yes | yes | no
3897 Arguments :
3898 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3899 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3900 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3901 closes.
3902
3903 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3904 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3905 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3906 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3907 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3908 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3909 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3910 properly tuned.
3911
3912 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3913 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3914 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3915
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003916 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3917
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003918 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3919
3920
3921mode { tcp|http|health }
3922 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3924 yes | yes | yes | yes
3925 Arguments :
3926 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3927 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3928 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3929 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3930
3931 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3932 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3933 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3934 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3935 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3936
3937 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003938 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3939 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3940 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3941 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3942 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3943 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3944 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003945
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003946 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3947 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3948 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003950 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003951 defaults http_instances
3952 mode http
3953
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003954 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003957monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003958 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961 Arguments :
3962 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3963 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003964 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3966 backend and its backup.
3967
3968 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3969 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3970 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3971 servers in a list of backends.
3972
3973 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3974 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3975 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3976 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3977 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3978 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3979 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003980 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3981 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003982
3983 Example:
3984 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003986 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3987 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3988 monitor-uri /site_alive
3989 monitor fail if site_dead
3990
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003991 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003992
3993
3994monitor-net <source>
3995 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | no
3998 Arguments :
3999 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4000 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4001 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4002 followed by a mask.
4003
4004 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4005 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004006 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004007 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4008
4009 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4010 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4011 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4012 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004013 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4014 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4015 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004016
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004017 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4018 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4019 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4020 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4021 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4022 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004023
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004024 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4025 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004026
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004027 Example :
4028 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4029 frontend www
4030 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4031
4032 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4033
4034
4035monitor-uri <uri>
4036 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 yes | yes | yes | no
4039 Arguments :
4040 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4041 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4042
4043 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4044 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4045 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4046 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4047 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4048 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4049 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4050 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4051
4052 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4053 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4054 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4055 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4056 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4057 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4058
4059 Example :
4060 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4061 frontend www
4062 mode http
4063 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4064
4065 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004067
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004068option abortonclose
4069no option abortonclose
4070 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 yes | no | yes | yes
4073 Arguments : none
4074
4075 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4076 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4077 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4078 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004079 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004080 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4081 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4082 encountered while delivering the response.
4083
4084 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4085 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4086 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4087 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4088 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4089 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004090 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004091 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004092 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004093 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4094 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4095 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4096
4097 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4098 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4099 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4100 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4101 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4102 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4103 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4104 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004105 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004106
4107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4109
4110 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4111
4112
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004113option accept-invalid-http-request
4114no option accept-invalid-http-request
4115 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4117 yes | yes | yes | no
4118 Arguments : none
4119
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004120 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004121 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4122 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4123 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4124 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4125 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4126 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4127 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004128 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4129 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4130 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4131 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4132 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004133 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004134 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4135 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4136 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004137
4138 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4139 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4140 been confirmed.
4141
4142 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4143 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004144 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4145 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004146 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4147
4148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4150
4151 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4152 stats socket.
4153
4154
4155option accept-invalid-http-response
4156no option accept-invalid-http-response
4157 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4159 yes | no | yes | yes
4160 Arguments : none
4161
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004162 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004163 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4164 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4165 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4166 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4167 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4168 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4169 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004170 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4171 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4172 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004173
4174 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4175 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4176 been confirmed.
4177
4178 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4179 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4180 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4181 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4182
4183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4185
4186 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4187 stats socket.
4188
4189
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004190option allbackups
4191no option allbackups
4192 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4194 yes | no | yes | yes
4195 Arguments : none
4196
4197 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4198 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4199 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4200 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4201 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4202 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4203 order between the backup servers anymore.
4204
4205 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4206 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4207
4208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4210
4211
4212option checkcache
4213no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004214 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | no | yes | yes
4217 Arguments : none
4218
4219 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4220 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004221 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004222 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4223 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004224 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004225
4226 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004227 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004228 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004229 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4230 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004231 to the client are :
4232 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004233 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004234 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004235 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4236 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4237 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4238 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4239 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4240 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4241 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4242 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4243 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4244 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4245 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4246
4247 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004248 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004249 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004250 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004251 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4252
4253 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4254 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004255 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004256 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4257
4258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4260
4261
4262option clitcpka
4263no option clitcpka
4264 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 yes | yes | yes | no
4267 Arguments : none
4268
4269 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4270 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4271 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4272 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4273
4274 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4275 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4276 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4277 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4278
4279 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4280 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4281 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4282 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4283 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4284
4285 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4286
4287 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4288 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4289 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4290
4291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4293
4294 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4295
4296
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297option contstats
4298 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | no
4301 Arguments : none
4302
4303 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4304 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4305 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4306 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4307 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4308 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4309 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4310
4311
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004312option dontlog-normal
4313no option dontlog-normal
4314 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 yes | yes | yes | no
4317 Arguments : none
4318
4319 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4320 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4321 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4322 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4323 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4324 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4325 logged.
4326
4327 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4328 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4329 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004331 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004332 logging.
4333
4334
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004335option dontlognull
4336no option dontlognull
4337 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments : none
4341
4342 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4343 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4344 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4345 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4346 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4347 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004348 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4349 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4350 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004351
4352 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4353 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4354 would not be logged.
4355
4356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4358
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004359 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4360 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004361
4362
4363option forceclose
4364no option forceclose
4365 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004367 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004368 Arguments : none
4369
4370 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4371 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4372 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4373 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4374 global session times in the logs.
4375
4376 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004377 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004378 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004379
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004380 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4381 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4382 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4383
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004384 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4385 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004386
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4389
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004390 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004391
4392
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004393option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004394 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | yes
4397 Arguments :
4398 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4399 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004400 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004401 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004402
4403 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4404 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4405 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4406 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4407 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4408 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4409 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004410 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4411 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4412 possible that the client has already brought one.
4413
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004414 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004415 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004416 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4417 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004418 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4419 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004420
4421 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4422 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4423 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4424 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4425 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4426 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4427 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4428
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004429 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4430 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4431 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4432 are under the control of the end-user.
4433
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004434 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004435 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4436 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004437 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4438 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4439 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004440
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004441 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4443 frontend www
4444 mode http
4445 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4446
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004447 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4448 backend www
4449 mode http
4450 option forwardfor header X-Client
4451
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004452 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004453 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004454
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004455
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004456option http-ignore-probes
4457no option http-ignore-probes
4458 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 yes | yes | yes | no
4461 Arguments : none
4462
4463 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4464 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4465 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4466 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4467 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4468 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4469 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4470 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4471 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4472 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4473 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4474 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4475
4476 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4477 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4478 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4479 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4480 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4481 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4482 are often the only way to detect them.
4483
4484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4486
4487 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4488
4489
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004490option http-keep-alive
4491no option http-keep-alive
4492 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 yes | yes | yes | yes
4495 Arguments : none
4496
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004497 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4498 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4499 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4500 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4501 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4502 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4503 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4504
4505 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4506 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004507 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4508 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4509 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4510 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4511 situations where this option may be useful :
4512
4513 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4514 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4515
4516 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4517 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4518
4519 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4520 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4521 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4522 request.
4523
4524 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4525 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004526 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4527 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4528 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004529
4530 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4531 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4532
4533 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4534 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4535 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4536 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4537 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4538 not set.
4539
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004540 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4541 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004542 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004543 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004544
4545 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004546 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4547 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004548
4549
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004550option http-no-delay
4551no option http-no-delay
4552 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | yes | yes | yes
4555 Arguments : none
4556
4557 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4558 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4559 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4560 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4561 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4562 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4563 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4564 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4565 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4566 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4567 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4568 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4569 affected.
4570
4571 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4572 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4573 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4574 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4575 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4576 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4577 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4578 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4579 latency environments.
4580
4581
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004582option http-pretend-keepalive
4583no option http-pretend-keepalive
4584 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | yes | yes | yes
4587 Arguments : none
4588
4589 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4590 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4591 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4592 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4593 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4594 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4595 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4596 consider the response complete.
4597
4598 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4599 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4600 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4601 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4602 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4603 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4604
4605 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4606 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4607 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4608 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4609 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4610 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4611 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4612
4613 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4614 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004615 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004616 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4617 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004618
4619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4621
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004622 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4623 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004624
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004625
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004626option http-server-close
4627no option http-server-close
4628 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 yes | yes | yes | yes
4631 Arguments : none
4632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4634 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4635 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4636 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4637 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4638 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4639 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4640 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4641 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4642 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4643 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4644 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4645 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4646 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4647 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4648 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004649
4650 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4651 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4652 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4653 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004654 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4655 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004656
4657 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4658 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004659 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4660 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004661 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4662 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004663
4664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4666
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004667 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004668 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4669 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004670
4671
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004672option http-tunnel
4673no option http-tunnel
4674 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 yes | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments : none
4678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4680 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4681 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4682 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4683 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4684 "option http-tunnel".
4685
4686 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004687 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004688 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4689 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4690 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4691 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4692 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4693 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4694 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004695
4696 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4697 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4698
4699 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4700 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4701 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4702
4703
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004704option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004705no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004706 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | yes | yes | no
4709 Arguments : none
4710
4711 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4712 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4713 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4714 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4715 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4716 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4717 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4718
4719 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4720 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4721 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4722 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4723 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4724 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4725 request along its whole life.
4726
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004727 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4728 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4729 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4730 front of an existing proxy.
4731
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004732 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4733
4734 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4735 http-server-close".
4736
4737
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004738option httpchk
4739option httpchk <uri>
4740option httpchk <method> <uri>
4741option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4742 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 yes | no | yes | yes
4745 Arguments :
4746 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4747 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4748 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4749 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4750 ones.
4751
4752 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4753 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4754 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4755
4756 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4757 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4758 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4759 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4760 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4761
4762 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4763 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4764 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4765 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4766 the lack of any response.
4767
4768 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4769
4770 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4771 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4772 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4773
4774 Examples :
4775 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4776 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4777 backend https_relay
4778 mode tcp
4779 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4780 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4781
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004782 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4783 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4784 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004785
4786
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004787option httpclose
4788no option httpclose
4789 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 yes | yes | yes | yes
4792 Arguments : none
4793
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004794 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4795 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4796 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4797 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004798 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004799 "option http-tunnel".
4800
4801 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4802 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4803 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4804 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4805 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4806 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4807 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4808 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004809
4810 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004811 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004812 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4813 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4814 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4815 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4816 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004817
4818 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4819 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004820 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4821 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004822 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4823 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004824
4825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4827
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004828 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4829 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004830
4831
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004832option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004833 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004836 Arguments :
4837 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4838 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4839 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4840 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4841 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004842
4843 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4844 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4845 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4846 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4847 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4848 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4849 ports.
4850
4851 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4852
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004853 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4854 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004856 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004858
4859option http_proxy
4860no option http_proxy
4861 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | yes | yes | yes
4864 Arguments : none
4865
4866 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4867 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4868 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4869 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4870 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4871
4872 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4873 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4874 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4875 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004876 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004877 be analyzed.
4878
4879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4881
4882 Example :
4883 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4884 backend direct_forward
4885 option httpclose
4886 option http_proxy
4887
4888 See also : "option httpclose"
4889
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004890
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004891option independent-streams
4892no option independent-streams
4893 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 yes | yes | yes | yes
4896 Arguments : none
4897
4898 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4899 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4900 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4901 receive data or not.
4902
4903 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4904 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4905 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4906 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4907 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4908 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4909 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4910 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4911 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4912 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4913 socket buffers.
4914
4915 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4916 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4917 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4918 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4919 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4920
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004921 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004922 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4923 deprecated.
4924
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004925 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004926
4927
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004928option ldap-check
4929 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | no | yes | yes
4932 Arguments : none
4933
4934 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4935 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4936 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4937 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4938
4939 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4940 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4941
4942 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4943 configure it.
4944
4945 Example :
4946 option ldap-check
4947
4948 See also : "option httpchk"
4949
4950
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004951option external-check
4952 Use external processes for server health checks
4953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 yes | no | yes | yes
4955
4956 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4957 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4958 command".
4959
4960 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4961
4962 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4963
4964
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004965option log-health-checks
4966no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004967 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | no | yes | yes
4970 Arguments : none
4971
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004972 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4973 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4974 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004975
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004976 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4977 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4978 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4979 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4980 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4981
4982 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4983 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004984
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004985 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4986 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4987 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004988
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004989
4990option log-separate-errors
4991no option log-separate-errors
4992 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | yes | yes | no
4995 Arguments : none
4996
4997 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4998 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4999 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5000 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5001 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5002 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5003 provides very important information.
5004
5005 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5006 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5007 error logs.
5008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005009 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005010 logging.
5011
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005012
5013option logasap
5014no option logasap
5015 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | no
5018 Arguments : none
5019
5020 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5021 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5022 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5023 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5024 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5025 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5026 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005027 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005028 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5029 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005031 Examples :
5032 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5033 mode http
5034 option httplog
5035 option logasap
5036 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5037
5038 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5039 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5040 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5041 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005043 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005044 logging.
5045
5046
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005047option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005048 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5050 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005051 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005052 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5053 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005054 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005055
5056 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5057 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5058 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5059 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5060 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5061 in the MySQL table, like this :
5062
5063 USE mysql;
5064 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5065 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5066
5067 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5068 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5069 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5070 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5071 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5072 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5073 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5074 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5075 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5076
5077 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5078 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005079
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005080 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005081
5082 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5083 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5084 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5085 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5086 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5087 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5088
5089 See also: "option httpchk"
5090
5091
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005092option nolinger
5093no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005094 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005097 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005098
5099 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5100 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5101 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5102 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5103 connections.
5104
5105 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5106 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5107 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5108 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5109 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5110 this too.
5111
5112 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5113 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5114 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5115
5116 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5117 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5118 for servers.
5119
5120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5122
5123
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005124option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5125 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | yes | yes | yes
5128 Arguments :
5129 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5130 matching <network>
5131 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5132 header name.
5133
5134 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5135 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5136 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5137 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5138 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5139 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5140 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5141 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5142 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5143 possible that the client has already brought one.
5144
5145 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5146 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5147 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5148 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5149 header and requires different one.
5150
5151 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5152 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5153 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5154 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5155 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5156 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5157 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5158
5159 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5160 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5161 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5162 both are defined.
5163
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005164 Examples :
5165 # Original Destination address
5166 frontend www
5167 mode http
5168 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5169
5170 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5171 backend www
5172 mode http
5173 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5174
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005175 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5176 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005177
5178
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005179option persist
5180no option persist
5181 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005184 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005185
5186 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5187 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5188 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5189 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5190 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5191 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5192 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5193 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5194 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5195 redirected to another valid server.
5196
5197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5199
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005200 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005201
5202
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005203option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5204 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | no | yes | yes
5207 Arguments :
5208 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5209 PostgreSQL server.
5210
5211 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5212 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5213 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5214 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5215
5216 See also: "option httpchk"
5217
5218
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005219option prefer-last-server
5220no option prefer-last-server
5221 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | no | yes | yes
5224 Arguments : none
5225
5226 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5227 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5228 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5229 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5230 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5231 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5232 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5233 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5234 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005235 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5236 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5237 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5238 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5239 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5240 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5241 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005242
5243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5245
5246 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5247
5248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005249option redispatch
5250no option redispatch
5251 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005254 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005255
5256 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5257 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5258 be able to access the service anymore.
5259
5260 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5261 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5262
5263 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5264 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5265 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005267 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5268 "redisp" keywords.
5269
5270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5272
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005273 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005274
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005275
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005276option redis-check
5277 Use redis health checks for server testing
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | no | yes | yes
5280 Arguments : none
5281
5282 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5283 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5284 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5285 find the "+PONG" response message.
5286
5287 Example :
5288 option redis-check
5289
5290 See also : "option httpchk"
5291
5292
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005293option smtpchk
5294option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5295 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5297 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005298 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005299 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5300 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5301 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5302
5303 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5304 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5305 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5306
5307 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5308 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5309 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5310 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5311 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5312 dead server.
5313
5314 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5315 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5316 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5317 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5318
5319 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5320 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5321 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5322 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5323 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5324
5325 Example :
5326 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5327
5328 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005331option socket-stats
5332no option socket-stats
5333
5334 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | yes | yes | no
5337
5338 Arguments : none
5339
5340
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005341option splice-auto
5342no option splice-auto
5343 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | yes | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : none
5347
5348 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5349 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5350 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5351 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005352 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005353 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5354 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5355 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5356 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5357
5358 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5359 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5360 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5361 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5362 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5363 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5364 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5365 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5366 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5367 keyword.
5368
5369 Example :
5370 option splice-auto
5371
5372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5374
5375 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5376 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5377
5378
5379option splice-request
5380no option splice-request
5381 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5383 yes | yes | yes | yes
5384 Arguments : none
5385
5386 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005387 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005388 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5389 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5390 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5391 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5392
5393 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5394
5395 Example :
5396 option splice-request
5397
5398 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5399 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5400
5401 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5402 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5403
5404
5405option splice-response
5406no option splice-response
5407 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5409 yes | yes | yes | yes
5410 Arguments : none
5411
5412 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005413 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005414 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5415 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5416 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5417 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5418
5419 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5420
5421 Example :
5422 option splice-response
5423
5424 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5425 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5426
5427 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5428 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5429
5430
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005431option srvtcpka
5432no option srvtcpka
5433 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 yes | no | yes | yes
5436 Arguments : none
5437
5438 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5439 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5440 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5441 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5442
5443 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5444 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5445 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5446 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5447
5448 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5449 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5450 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5451 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5452 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5453
5454 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5455
5456 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5457 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5458 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5459
5460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5462
5463 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5464
5465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005466option ssl-hello-chk
5467 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | no | yes | yes
5470 Arguments : none
5471
5472 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5473 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5474 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5475 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5476 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5477 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5478 hello message.
5479
5480 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5481 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5482 messages, which is appreciable.
5483
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005484 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5485 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5486 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005487
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005488 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5489
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005490
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005491option tcp-check
5492 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | no | yes | yes
5495
5496 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5497 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5498
5499 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5500 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5501 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5502
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005503 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005504 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5505 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5506 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5507 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5508 only.
5509
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005510 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005511 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5512 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5513 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5514 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5515
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005516 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005517 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5518 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005519 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005520 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5521 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5522 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5523 the respective protocols.
5524 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5525 analysed.
5526
5527 Examples :
5528 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5529 option tcp-check
5530 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5531
5532 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5533 option tcp-check
5534 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5535
5536 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5537 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005538 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005539 option tcp-check
5540 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5541 tcp-check expect +PONG
5542 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5543 tcp-check expect string role:master
5544 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5545 tcp-check expect string +OK
5546
5547 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5548 (send many headers before analyzing)
5549 option tcp-check
5550 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5551 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5552 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5553 tcp-check send \r\n
5554 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5555
5556
5557 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5558
5559
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005560option tcp-smart-accept
5561no option tcp-smart-accept
5562 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5564 yes | yes | yes | no
5565 Arguments : none
5566
5567 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5568 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5569 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5570 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5571 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5572 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5573
5574 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5575 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5576 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5577 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5578
5579 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5580 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5581 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5582 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5583
5584 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5585 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5586 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5587
5588 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5589 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5590 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5591
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005592 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5593
5594
5595option tcp-smart-connect
5596no option tcp-smart-connect
5597 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 yes | no | yes | yes
5600 Arguments : none
5601
5602 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5603 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5604 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5605 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5606 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5607
5608 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5609 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5610 complex.
5611
5612 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5613 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5614 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5615
5616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5618
5619 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5620
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005621
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005622option tcpka
5623 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5625 yes | yes | yes | yes
5626 Arguments : none
5627
5628 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5629 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5630 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5631 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5632
5633 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5634 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5635 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5636 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5637
5638 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5639 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5640 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5641 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5642 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5643
5644 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5645
5646 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5647 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5648 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5649 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5650 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5651 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5652 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5653 backends.
5654
5655 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5656
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005657
5658option tcplog
5659 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 yes | yes | yes | yes
5662 Arguments : none
5663
5664 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5665 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5666 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5667 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5668 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5669 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5670 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5671 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5672
5673 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005675 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005676
5677
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005678option transparent
5679no option transparent
5680 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005682 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005683 Arguments : none
5684
5685 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5686 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5687 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5688 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5689 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5690 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5691 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5692 appropriate server.
5693
5694 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5695 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5696
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005697 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005698 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005699
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005700
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005701external-check command <command>
5702 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 yes | no | yes | yes
5705
5706 Arguments :
5707 <command> is the external command to run
5708
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005709 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5710
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005711 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005712
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005713 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5714 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5715 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5716 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5717 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5718 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005719
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005720 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5721
5722 Environment variables :
5723 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5724 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5725
5726 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5727
5728 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5729
5730 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5731 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5732 for a UNIX socket).
5733
5734 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5735
5736 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5737
5738 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5739
5740 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5741
5742 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5743
5744 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5745 socket).
5746
5747 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5748 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5749
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005750 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5751 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5752 failed.
5753
5754 Example :
5755 external-check command /bin/true
5756
5757 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5758
5759
5760external-check path <path>
5761 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 yes | no | yes | yes
5764
5765 Arguments :
5766 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5767
5768 The default path is "".
5769
5770 Example :
5771 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5772
5773 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5774 "external-check command"
5775
5776
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005777persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005778persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005779 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | no | yes | yes
5782 Arguments :
5783 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005784 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5785 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005786
5787 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5788 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5789 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5790 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5791 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5792 forwarded to this server.
5793
5794 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5795 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5796 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005797 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005798 a single "listen" section.
5799
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005800 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5801 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5802 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5803
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005804 Example :
5805 listen tse-farm
5806 bind :3389
5807 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5808 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5809 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5810 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5811 persist rdp-cookie
5812 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005813 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005814 balance rdp-cookie
5815 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5816 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5817
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005818 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5819 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005820
5821
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005822rate-limit sessions <rate>
5823 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | yes | yes | no
5826 Arguments :
5827 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5828 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5829
5830 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5831 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5832 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5833 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5834 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5835 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5836
5837 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5838 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5839 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5840 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5841
5842 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5843 listen smtp
5844 mode tcp
5845 bind :25
5846 rate-limit sessions 10
5847 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5848
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005849 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5850 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5851 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005852
5853 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5854
5855
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005856redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5857redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5858redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005859 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5861 no | yes | yes | yes
5862
5863 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005864 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005865
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005867 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005868 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5869 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5870 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005871
5872 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5873 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5874 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5875 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5876 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005877 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5878 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5879 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5880 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005881
5882 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5883 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5884 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5885 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5886 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5887 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005888 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005889 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005890 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5891 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5892 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005893
5894 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005895 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5896 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5897 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5898 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5899 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5900 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5901 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5902 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005903
5904 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5905 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5906
5907 - "drop-query"
5908 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5909 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5910 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5911 with a location-type redirect.
5912
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005913 - "append-slash"
5914 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5915 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5916 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5917 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5918
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005919 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5920 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5921 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5922 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5923 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5924 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5925 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5926
5927 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5928 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5929 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5930 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5931 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5932 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5933 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005934
5935 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5936 acl clear dst_port 80
5937 acl secure dst_port 8080
5938 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005939 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005940 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005941 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5942
5943 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005944 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5945 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5946 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005947 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005948
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005949 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5950 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5951 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5952
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005953 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005954 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005955
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005956 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5957 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5958 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005960 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005961
5962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005963redisp (deprecated)
5964redispatch (deprecated)
5965 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005968 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005969
5970 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5971 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5972 be able to access the service anymore.
5973
5974 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5975 redistribute them to a working server.
5976
5977 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5978 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5979 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005981 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5982 "option redispatch" instead.
5983
5984 See also : "option redispatch"
5985
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005986
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005987reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005988 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 no | yes | yes | yes
5991 Arguments :
5992 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5993 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005994 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005995
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005996 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5997 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5998
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005999 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6000 the last header of an HTTP request.
6001
6002 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6003 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6004 responses.
6005
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006006 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6007 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6008 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6009
6010 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6011 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006012
6013
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006014reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6015reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006016 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6018 no | yes | yes | yes
6019 Arguments :
6020 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6021 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6022 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6023 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6024 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6025 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6026 ignores case.
6027
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006028 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6029 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6030
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006031 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6032 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6033 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6034 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006035 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006036
6037 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6038 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6039
6040 Example :
6041 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6042 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6043 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6044
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006045 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6046 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006047
6048
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006049reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6050reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006051 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6053 no | yes | yes | yes
6054 Arguments :
6055 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6056 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6057 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6058 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6059 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6060 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6061
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006062 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6063 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6064
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006065 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6066 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6067 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6068 next servers.
6069
6070 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6071 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6072 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6073
6074 Example :
6075 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6076 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6077 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6078
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006079 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6080 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006081
6082
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006083reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6084reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006085 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 no | yes | yes | yes
6088 Arguments :
6089 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6090 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6091 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6092 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6093 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6094 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6095 case.
6096
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006097 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6098 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6099
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006100 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6101 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6102 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6103 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006104 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006105
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006106 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006107 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006108 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006109
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006110 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6111 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6112
6113 Example :
6114 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6115 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6116 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6117
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006118 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6119 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006120
6121
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006122reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6123reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006124 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6126 no | yes | yes | yes
6127 Arguments :
6128 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6129 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6130 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6131 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6132 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6133 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6134 case.
6135
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006136 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6137 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6138
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006139 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6140 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6141 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6142 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6143
6144 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6145 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6146
6147 Example :
6148 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6149 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6150 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6151 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6152
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006153 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6154 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006155
6156
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006157reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6158reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006159 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6161 no | yes | yes | yes
6162 Arguments :
6163 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6164 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6165 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6166 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6167 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6168 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6169
6170 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6171 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6172 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6173 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006174 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006175
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006176 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6177 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6178
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006179 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6180 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6181 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6182
6183 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6184 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6185 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6186 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6187 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6188
6189 Example :
6190 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006191 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006192 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6193 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6194
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006195 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6196 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006197
6198
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006199reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6200reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006201 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 no | yes | yes | yes
6204 Arguments :
6205 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6206 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6207 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6208 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6209 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6210 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6211 ignores case.
6212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006213 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6214 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6215
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006216 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6217 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006218 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6219 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6220 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006221 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6222 not set.
6223
6224 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6225 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6226 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6227 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6228 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6229
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006230 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006231 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6232 # block all others.
6233 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6234 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6235
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006236 # block bad guys
6237 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6238 reqitarpit . if badguys
6239
6240 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6241 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006242
6243
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006244retries <value>
6245 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6247 yes | no | yes | yes
6248 Arguments :
6249 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6250 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6251 default value is 3.
6252
6253 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6254 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6255 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6256
6257 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6258 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6259
6260 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6261 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6262
6263 See also : "option redispatch"
6264
6265
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006266rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006267 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 no | yes | yes | yes
6270 Arguments :
6271 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6272 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006273 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006274
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006275 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6276 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6277
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006278 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6279 the last header of an HTTP response.
6280
6281 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6282 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6283 responses.
6284
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006285 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6286 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006287
6288
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006289rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6290rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006291 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 no | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments :
6295 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6296 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6297 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6298 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6299 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6300 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6301 ignores case.
6302
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006303 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6304 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6305
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006306 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6307 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006308 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006309 client.
6310
6311 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6312 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6313 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6314
6315 Example :
6316 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006317 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006318
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006319 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6320 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006321
6322
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006323rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6324rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006325 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6327 no | yes | yes | yes
6328 Arguments :
6329 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6330 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6331 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6332 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6333 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6334 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6335 ignores case.
6336
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006337 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6338 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6339
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006340 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6341 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6342 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6343 case-sensitive.
6344
6345 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006346 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6347 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6348 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006349
6350 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6351 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6352
6353 Example :
6354 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6355 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6356
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006357 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6358 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006359
6360
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006361rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6362rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006363 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 no | yes | yes | yes
6366 Arguments :
6367 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6368 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6369 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6370 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6371 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6372 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6373 ignores case.
6374
6375 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6376 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6377 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6378 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006379 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006380
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006384 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6385 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6386 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6387
6388 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6389 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6390 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6391 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6392 are not case-sensitive.
6393
6394 Example :
6395 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6396 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6397
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006398 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6399 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006400
6401
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006402server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006403 Declare a server in a backend
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 no | no | yes | yes
6406 Arguments :
6407 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006408 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006409 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006410
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006411 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6412 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6413 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6414 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006415 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6416 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6417 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6418 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6419 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006420 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6421 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6422 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6423 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6424 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6425 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6426 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006427 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006428 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6429 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6430 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6431 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006433 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006434 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6435 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6436 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6437 adding this value to the client's port.
6438
6439 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6440 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006441 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006442
6443 Examples :
6444 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6445 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006446 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006447 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6448 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6449 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006450
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006451 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6452 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006453
6454
6455source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006456source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006457source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006458 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6460 yes | no | yes | yes
6461 Arguments :
6462 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6463 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006464
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006465 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006466 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6467 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6468 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6469 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6470 supported prefixes are :
6471 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6472 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6473 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006474 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006475 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6476 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6477 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6478 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006479
6480 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6481 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006482 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6483 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6484 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006485
6486 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6487 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6488 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6489 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6490 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6491 <addr>.
6492
6493 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6494 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6495 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6496 port.
6497
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006498 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6499 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6500 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6501 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006502 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006503 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6504 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6505 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6506 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6507 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6508 HTTP header.
6509
6510 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6511 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006512 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006513 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6514 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6515 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6516 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6517 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6518 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6519 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6520
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006521 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6522 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6523 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6524 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6525 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6526 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6527
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006528 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6529 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6530 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6531 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6532
6533 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6534 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6535 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6536 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6537 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6538 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6539
6540 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6541 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6542 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6543 there are two methods :
6544
6545 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6546 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6547 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6548 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6549 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6550 of the client ranges may be used.
6551
6552 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6553 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6554 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6555 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6556 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6557 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6558 same session.
6559
6560 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6561 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6562 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6563 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6564 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6565 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6566
6567 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6568 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6569 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006570 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006571
6572 Examples :
6573 backend private
6574 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6575 source 192.168.1.200
6576
6577 backend transparent_ssl1
6578 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6579 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6580
6581 backend transparent_ssl2
6582 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6583 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6584 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6585
6586 backend transparent_ssl3
6587 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6588 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6589 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6590
6591 backend transparent_smtp
6592 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6593 # with Tproxy version 4.
6594 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6595
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006596 backend transparent_http
6597 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6598 # proxy.
6599 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006601 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006602 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006604
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006605srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6606 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | no | yes | yes
6609 Arguments :
6610 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6612 as explained at the top of this document.
6613
6614 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6615 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6616 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6617 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6618 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6619 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6620 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6621
6622 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6623 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6624 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6625 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6626 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006627 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006628 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006629 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006630
6631 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6637
6638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6639 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6640
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006641 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6642 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006643
6644
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006645stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6646 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006648 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006649
6650 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6651 matched.
6652
6653 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6654 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6655
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006656 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6657 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6658 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6659
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006660 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6661 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6662 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6663 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006664
6665 Example :
6666 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6667 backend stats_localhost
6668 stats enable
6669 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6670
6671 Example :
6672 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6673 backend stats_auth
6674 stats enable
6675 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6676 stats admin if TRUE
6677
6678 Example :
6679 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6680 userlist stats-auth
6681 group admin users admin
6682 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6683 group readonly users haproxy
6684 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6685
6686 backend stats_auth
6687 stats enable
6688 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6689 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6690 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6691 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6692
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006693 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6694 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6695 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006696
6697
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006698stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6699 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006701 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006702 Arguments :
6703 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6704
6705 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6706
6707 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6708 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6709 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6710 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6711 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6712 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6713
6714 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6715 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6716 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006717 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006718
6719 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6720 report using "stats scope".
6721
6722 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6723 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6724 unobvious parameters.
6725
6726 Example :
6727 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6728 backend public_www
6729 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6730 stats enable
6731 stats hide-version
6732 stats scope .
6733 stats uri /admin?stats
6734 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6735 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6736 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6737
6738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6739 backend private_monitoring
6740 stats enable
6741 stats uri /admin?stats
6742 stats refresh 5s
6743
6744 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6745
6746
6747stats enable
6748 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006750 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006751 Arguments : none
6752
6753 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6754 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6755 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6756 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6757 - stats auth : no authentication
6758 - stats scope : no restriction
6759
6760 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6761 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6762 unobvious parameters.
6763
6764 Example :
6765 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6766 backend public_www
6767 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6768 stats enable
6769 stats hide-version
6770 stats scope .
6771 stats uri /admin?stats
6772 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6773 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6774 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6775
6776 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6777 backend private_monitoring
6778 stats enable
6779 stats uri /admin?stats
6780 stats refresh 5s
6781
6782 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6783
6784
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006785stats hide-version
6786 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006788 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006789 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006791 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6792 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6793 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6794 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6795 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6796 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006798 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6799 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6800 unobvious parameters.
6801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006802 Example :
6803 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6804 backend public_www
6805 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006806 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006807 stats hide-version
6808 stats scope .
6809 stats uri /admin?stats
6810 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6811 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6812 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006813
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006814 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6815 backend private_monitoring
6816 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006817 stats uri /admin?stats
6818 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006819
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006820 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006821
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006822
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006823stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6824 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825 Access control for statistics
6826
6827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6828 no | no | yes | yes
6829
6830 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6831 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6832 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6833 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6834 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6835 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6836
6837 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6838 instance.
6839
6840 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6841 about ACL usage.
6842
6843
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006844stats realm <realm>
6845 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006847 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006848 Arguments :
6849 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6850 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6851 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6852
6853 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6854 using a backslash ('\').
6855
6856 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6857 only related to authentication.
6858
6859 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6860 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6861 unobvious parameters.
6862
6863 Example :
6864 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6865 backend public_www
6866 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6867 stats enable
6868 stats hide-version
6869 stats scope .
6870 stats uri /admin?stats
6871 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6872 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6873 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6874
6875 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6876 backend private_monitoring
6877 stats enable
6878 stats uri /admin?stats
6879 stats refresh 5s
6880
6881 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6882
6883
6884stats refresh <delay>
6885 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006887 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006888 Arguments :
6889 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6890 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6891 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6892 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6893 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6894 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6895
6896 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6897 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6898 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6899 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6900
6901 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6902 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6903 unobvious parameters.
6904
6905 Example :
6906 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6907 backend public_www
6908 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6909 stats enable
6910 stats hide-version
6911 stats scope .
6912 stats uri /admin?stats
6913 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6914 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6915 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6916
6917 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6918 backend private_monitoring
6919 stats enable
6920 stats uri /admin?stats
6921 stats refresh 5s
6922
6923 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6924
6925
6926stats scope { <name> | "." }
6927 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006929 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006930 Arguments :
6931 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6932 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6933 section in which the statement appears.
6934
6935 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6936 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6937 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6938 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6939 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6940 exists.
6941
6942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6944 unobvious parameters.
6945
6946 Example :
6947 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6948 backend public_www
6949 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6950 stats enable
6951 stats hide-version
6952 stats scope .
6953 stats uri /admin?stats
6954 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6955 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6956 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6957
6958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6959 backend private_monitoring
6960 stats enable
6961 stats uri /admin?stats
6962 stats refresh 5s
6963
6964 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6965
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006966
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006967stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006968 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006970 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006971
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006972 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006973 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6974
6975 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6976 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6977
6978 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6979 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006980 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006981
6982 Example :
6983 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6984 backend private_monitoring
6985 stats enable
6986 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6987 stats uri /admin?stats
6988 stats refresh 5s
6989
6990 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6991 global section.
6992
6993
6994stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006995 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 yes | yes | yes | yes
6998 Arguments : none
6999
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007000 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007001 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7002 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7003 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7004 - IP (socket, server)
7005 - cookie (backend, server)
7006
7007 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7008 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007009 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007010
7011 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7012
7013
7014stats show-node [ <name> ]
7015 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007018 Arguments:
7019 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7020 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7021
7022 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7023 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007024 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007025
7026 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7027 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7028 unobvious parameters.
7029
7030 Example:
7031 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7032 backend private_monitoring
7033 stats enable
7034 stats show-node Europe-1
7035 stats uri /admin?stats
7036 stats refresh 5s
7037
7038 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7039 section.
7040
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007041
7042stats uri <prefix>
7043 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007046 Arguments :
7047 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7048 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7049 query string.
7050
7051 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7052 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7053 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7054 possible to reach it in the application.
7055
7056 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007057 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007058 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7059 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7060 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7061 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7062
7063 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7064 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7065 an address or a port to statistics only.
7066
7067 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7068 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7069 unobvious parameters.
7070
7071 Example :
7072 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7073 backend public_www
7074 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7075 stats enable
7076 stats hide-version
7077 stats scope .
7078 stats uri /admin?stats
7079 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7080 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7081 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7082
7083 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7084 backend private_monitoring
7085 stats enable
7086 stats uri /admin?stats
7087 stats refresh 5s
7088
7089 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7090
7091
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007092stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7093 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007095 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007096
7097 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007098 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007099 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7100 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7101 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7102
7103 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7104 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7105 the "stick-table" statement.
7106
7107 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7108 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7109 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7110 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7111 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7112
7113 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7114 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7115 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7116 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7117 transformation rules.
7118
7119 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7120 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7121 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7122 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7123 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7124 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7125 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7126
7127 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7128 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7129 ACL based conditions.
7130
7131 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7132 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7133 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7134 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7135
7136 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7137 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7138 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7139 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7140
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007141 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7142 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7143 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7144
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007145 Example :
7146 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7147 # last 30 minutes
7148 backend pop
7149 mode tcp
7150 balance roundrobin
7151 stick store-request src
7152 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7153 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7154 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7155
7156 backend smtp
7157 mode tcp
7158 balance roundrobin
7159 stick match src table pop
7160 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7161 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7162
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007163 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007164 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007165
7166
7167stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7168 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 no | no | yes | yes
7171
7172 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7173 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7174 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7175 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7176
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007177 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7178 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7179 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7180
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007181 Examples :
7182 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007183 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007184
7185 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7186 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7187 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7188
7189
7190 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7191 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7192 backend http
7193 mode http
7194 balance roundrobin
7195 stick on src table https
7196 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7197 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7198 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7199
7200 backend https
7201 mode tcp
7202 balance roundrobin
7203 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7204 stick on src
7205 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7206 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7207
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007208 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007209
7210
7211stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7212 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 no | no | yes | yes
7215
7216 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007217 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007218 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7219 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7220 server is selected.
7221
7222 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7223 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7224 the "stick-table" statement.
7225
7226 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7227 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7228 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7229 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7230 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7231 address.
7232
7233 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7234 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7235 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7236 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7237 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7238 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7239 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7240 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7241 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7242 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7243
7244 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7245 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7246 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7247 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7248 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7249 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7250 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7251
7252 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7253 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7254 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7255 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7256
7257 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7258 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7259 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7260 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7261 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7262 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007263 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7264 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7265 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7266 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7267 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7268 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007269
7270 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7271 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7272 the request.
7273
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007274 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7275 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7276 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7277
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007278 Example :
7279 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7280 # last 30 minutes
7281 backend pop
7282 mode tcp
7283 balance roundrobin
7284 stick store-request src
7285 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7286 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7287 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7288
7289 backend smtp
7290 mode tcp
7291 balance roundrobin
7292 stick match src table pop
7293 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7294 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7295
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007296 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007297 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007298
7299
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007300stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007301 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7302 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007303 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007305 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007306
7307 Arguments :
7308 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7309 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7310 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7311 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7312
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007313 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7314 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7315 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7316 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7317
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007318 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7319 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7320 instance.
7321
7322 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7323 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7324 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7325 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7326 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7327 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007328 to 32 characters.
7329
7330 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7331 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7332 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007333 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007334 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7335 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007336
7337 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007338 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7339 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007340 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7341 increase.
7342
7343 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007344 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7345 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7346 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007347
7348 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7349 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7350 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7351 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7352 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7353 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7354 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7355 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7356 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7357 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7358 parameter (see below).
7359
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007360 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7361 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7362 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7363 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7364 soft restart.
7365
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007366 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7367 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007368
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007369 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7370 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7371 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7372 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7373 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007374 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007375 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7376 if not expiration delay is specified.
7377
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007378 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7379 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7380 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7381 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007382 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7383 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7384 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7385 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7386 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7387 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7388 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7389 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7390 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7391 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7392 types and their arguments.
7393
7394 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7395 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7396 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7397 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7398
7399 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7400 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7401 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7402 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7403
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007404 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7405 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7406 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7407 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7408 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7409 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7410
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007411 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7412 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7413 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7414 they were received.
7415
7416 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7417 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7418 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7419 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7420 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7421
7422 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7423 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7424 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7425 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7426 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7427
7428 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7429 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7430 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7431
7432 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7433 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7434 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7435 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7436 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7437
7438 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7439 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7440 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7441 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7442 the client side.
7443
7444 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7445 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7446 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7447 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7448 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7449 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7450 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7451
7452 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7453 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7454 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7455 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7456 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7457 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7458 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7459
7460 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7461 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7462 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7463 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7464 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7465 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7466
7467 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7468 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7469 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7470 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7471
7472 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7473 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7474 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7475 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7476 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7477 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7478 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7479 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7480 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7481 recommended for better fairness.
7482
7483 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7484 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7485 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7486 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7487
7488 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7489 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7490 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7491 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7492 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7493 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7494 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7495 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7496 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7497 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007498
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007499 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7500 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007501 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7502 reference it.
7503
7504 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7505 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7506 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7507 as an exclusive stickiness.
7508
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007509 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7510 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7511 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7512 something that can be ignored.
7513
7514 Example:
7515 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7516 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7517 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7518 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7519
7520 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007521 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007522
7523
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007524stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7525 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7527 no | no | yes | yes
7528
7529 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007530 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007531 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7532 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7533 server is selected.
7534
7535 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7536 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7537 the "stick-table" statement.
7538
7539 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7540 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7541 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7542 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7543
7544 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7545 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7546 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7547 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7548 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7549 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007550 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007551 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7552 rules.
7553
7554 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7555 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7556 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7557 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7558 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7559 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7560 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7561
7562 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7563 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7564 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7565 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7566
7567 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7568 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7569 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7570 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7571 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7572 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007573 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7574 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7575 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7576 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7577 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7578 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7579 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7580 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7581 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007582
7583 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7584
7585 Example :
7586 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7587 backend https
7588 mode tcp
7589 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007590 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007591 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007592
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007593 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7594 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7595
7596 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7597 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7598 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7599
7600 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7601 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007602
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007603 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7604 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7605 # at offset 44.
7606
7607 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7608 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7609
7610 # Learn on response if server hello.
7611 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007612
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007613 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7614 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7615
7616 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7617 extraction.
7618
7619
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007620tcp-check connect [params*]
7621 Opens a new connection
7622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 no | no | yes | yes
7624
7625 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7626 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7627 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7628
7629 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7630 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7631 of the sequence.
7632
7633 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7634 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7635 do.
7636
7637 Parameters :
7638 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7639 use the TCP connection.
7640
7641 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7642 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7643 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7644
7645 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7646
7647 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7648
7649 Examples:
7650 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7651 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7652 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7653 option tcp-check
7654 tcp-check connect
7655 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7656 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7657 tcp-check send \r\n
7658 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7659 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7660 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7661 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7662 tcp-check send \r\n
7663 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7664 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7665
7666 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7667 option tcp-check
7668 tcp-check connect port 110
7669 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7670 tcp-check connect port 143
7671 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7672 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7673
7674 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7675
7676
7677tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7678 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7680 no | no | yes | yes
7681
7682 Arguments :
7683 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7684 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7685 binary.
7686 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7687 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7688 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7689
7690 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7691 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7692 with the usual backslash ('\').
7693 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7694 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7695 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7696 used upper or lower case.
7697
7698
7699 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7700
7701 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7702 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7703 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7704 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7705 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7706 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7707 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7708 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7709
7710 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7711 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7712 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7713 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7714 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7715 expression.
7716
7717 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7718 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7719 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7720 this exact hexadecimal string.
7721 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7722
7723 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7724 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7725 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7726 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7727 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7728 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7729 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7730 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7731 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7732 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7733 the null character.
7734
7735 Examples :
7736 # perform a POP check
7737 option tcp-check
7738 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7739
7740 # perform an IMAP check
7741 option tcp-check
7742 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7743
7744 # look for the redis master server
7745 option tcp-check
7746 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7747 tcp-check expect +PONG
7748 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7749 tcp-check expect string role:master
7750 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7751 tcp-check expect string +OK
7752
7753
7754 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7755 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7756
7757
7758tcp-check send <data>
7759 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 no | no | yes | yes
7762
7763 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7764 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7765
7766 Examples :
7767 # look for the redis master server
7768 option tcp-check
7769 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7770 tcp-check expect string role:master
7771
7772 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7773 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7774
7775
7776tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7777 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7778 tcp health check
7779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7780 no | no | yes | yes
7781
7782 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7783 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7784 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7785 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7786 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7787 hexadecimal string.
7788 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7789
7790 Examples :
7791 # redis check in binary
7792 option tcp-check
7793 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7794 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7795
7796
7797 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7798 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7799
7800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007801tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7802 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7804 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007805 Arguments :
7806 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007807 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7808 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007809
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007810 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007811
7812 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7813 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007814 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7815 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7816 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7817 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7818 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7819 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007821 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7822 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7823 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7824 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007825
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007826 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007827 - accept :
7828 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7829 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7830 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007832 - reject :
7833 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7834 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7835 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7836 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7837 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7838 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7839 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7840 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7841 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7842 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7843 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7844 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007845
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007846 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7847 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7848 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7849 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7850 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7851 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7852 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7853 hosts.
7854
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007855 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7856 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7857 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7858 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7859 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7860 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7861 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7862 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7863 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7864 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7865 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7866
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007867 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007868 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007869 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007870 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007871 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7872 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007873 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007874 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7875 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7876 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7877 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7878 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007880 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007881 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007882 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007883 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7884 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7885 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7886 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7889 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7890 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7891 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007893 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7894 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7895 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7896 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7897 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007898 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7899 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7900 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7901 layer7 information is extracted.
7902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007903 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7904 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7905 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7906 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7907 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007909 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7910 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7911 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7914 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7915 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007917 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007918 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007919 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007921 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7922 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7923 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007925 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007926 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7927 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007928
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007929 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7930
7931 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7932
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007933 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7934
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007935 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007936
7937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007938tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7939 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007941 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007942 Arguments :
7943 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007944 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007945 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7946 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007948 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007950 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7951 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7952 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7953 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7954 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007956 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7957 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7958 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7959 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007960 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7961 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7962 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7963 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7964 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7965 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007966 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007967 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007969 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7970 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7971 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7972 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007973
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007974 Four types of actions are supported :
7975 - accept : the request is accepted
7976 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7977 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007978 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007980 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7981 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007982
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007983 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7984 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7985 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7986 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7987 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7988 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007990 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007991 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7992 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007994 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007995 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7996 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7997 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7998 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007999 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8000 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8001 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008002
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008003 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008004 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8005 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8006 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008007
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008008 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8009 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8010 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8011 documentation.
8012
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008013 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008014 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8015 # and reject everything else.
8016 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8017 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008018 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008019 tcp-request content reject
8020
8021 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008022 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8023 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8024 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008025 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008026
8027 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8028 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8029 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008030 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008031 tcp-request content reject
8032
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008033 Example:
8034 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8035 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008036 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008037
8038 Example:
8039 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8040 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008041 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008043 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8044 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8045
8046 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008047 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008048 # protecting all our sites
8049 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008050 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8051 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008052 ...
8053 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8054
8055 backend http_dynamic
8056 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008057 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008058 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008059 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8060 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8061 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008062 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008064 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008066 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008067
8068
8069tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8070 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008072 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008073 Arguments :
8074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8076 as explained at the top of this document.
8077
8078 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8079 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8080 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8081 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8082 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8083
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008084 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8085 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8086 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8087 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8088
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008089 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8090 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008091 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008092 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008093 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8094 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8095 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8096 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008097
8098 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8099 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8100 it pass through unaffected.
8101
8102 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8103 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8104 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008105 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008106 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8107 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008108 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8109 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8110 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008111
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008112 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008113 "timeout client".
8114
8115
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008116tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8117 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8119 no | no | yes | yes
8120 Arguments :
8121 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008122 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008123
8124 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8125
8126 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8127 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8128 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008129 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8130 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008131
8132 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8133
8134 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8135 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8136 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8137 inserted.
8138
8139 Two types of actions are supported :
8140 - accept :
8141 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8142 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8143 the rules evaluation.
8144
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008145 - close :
8146 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8147 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8148 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8149 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8150 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8151 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008152 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008153 protocols.
8154
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008155 - reject :
8156 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8157 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008158 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008159
8160 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8161 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8162 for changing the default action to a reject.
8163
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008164 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8165 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8166 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8167 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008168 period.
8169
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008170 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8171 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8172 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8173 documentation.
8174
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008175 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8176
8177 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8178
8179
8180tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8181 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 no | no | yes | yes
8184 Arguments :
8185 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8186 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8187 as explained at the top of this document.
8188
8189 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8190
8191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008192timeout check <timeout>
8193 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8194 established.
8195
8196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8197 yes | no | yes | yes
8198 Arguments:
8199 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8201 as explained at the top of this document.
8202
8203 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8204 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8205 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8206 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008207 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8208 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8209 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008210
8211 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8212 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8213
8214 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8215 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008216 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008217
8218 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8219 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8220 forget about it.
8221
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008222 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8223 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008224
8225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008226timeout client <timeout>
8227timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8228 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 yes | yes | yes | no
8231 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8234 as explained at the top of this document.
8235
8236 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8237 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8238 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8239 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8240 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8241 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8242 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8243 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008244 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008245 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008246 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8247 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008248 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8249 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008250
8251 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8252 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8253 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8254 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8255 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8256 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8257
8258 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8259 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8260 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8261
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008262 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008263
8264
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008265timeout client-fin <timeout>
8266 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8268 yes | yes | yes | no
8269 Arguments :
8270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8272 as explained at the top of this document.
8273
8274 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8275 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8276 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8277 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8278 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8279 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8280 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8281 down in one direction.
8282
8283 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8284 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8285 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8286
8287 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8288
8289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008290timeout connect <timeout>
8291timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8292 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | no | yes | yes
8295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008296 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008297 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8298 as explained at the top of this document.
8299
8300 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008301 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008302 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008303 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008304 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8305 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008306
8307 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8308 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8309 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8310 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8311 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8312 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8313
8314 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8315 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8316 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8317
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008318 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8319 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008320
8321
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008322timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8323 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 yes | yes | yes | yes
8326 Arguments :
8327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8329 as explained at the top of this document.
8330
8331 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8332 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8333 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8334 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8335 once the request has started to present itself.
8336
8337 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8338 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8339 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8340 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8341 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8342
8343 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8344 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8345 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8346 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8347
8348 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8349 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8350 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8351 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8352 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008353 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008354
8355 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8356 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8357 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8358 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8359
8360 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8361
8362
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008363timeout http-request <timeout>
8364 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008366 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008367 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008368 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008369 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8370 as explained at the top of this document.
8371
8372 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8373 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8374 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8375 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8376 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8377 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8378 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008379 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8380 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8381 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8382 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8383 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008384 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8385 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008386
8387 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8388 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008389 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8390 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008391
8392 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8393 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8394 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8395 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8396 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8397
8398 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008399 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8400 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8401 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008402
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008403 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8404 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008405
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008406
8407timeout queue <timeout>
8408 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8410 yes | no | yes | yes
8411 Arguments :
8412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8414 as explained at the top of this document.
8415
8416 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8417 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8418 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8419 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8420 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8421
8422 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8423 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8424 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8425 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8426
8427 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8428
8429
8430timeout server <timeout>
8431timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8432 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8434 yes | no | yes | yes
8435 Arguments :
8436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8438 as explained at the top of this document.
8439
8440 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8441 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8442 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8443 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8444 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8445 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8446 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8447
8448 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8449 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8450 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8451 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8452 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008453 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008454 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008455 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8456 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8457 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8458 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008459
8460 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8461 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8462 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8463 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8464 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8465 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8466
8467 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8468 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8469 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8470
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008471 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008472
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008473
8474timeout server-fin <timeout>
8475 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8477 yes | no | yes | yes
8478 Arguments :
8479 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8480 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8481 as explained at the top of this document.
8482
8483 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8484 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8485 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8486 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8487 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8488 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8489 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8490 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8491 situations, it should not be needed.
8492
8493 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8494 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8495 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8496
8497 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8498
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008499
8500timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008501 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8503 yes | yes | yes | yes
8504 Arguments :
8505 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8506 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8507 as explained at the top of this document.
8508
8509 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8510 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8511 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8512
8513 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8514 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8515 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8516 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008517 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008518
8519 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8520
8521
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008522timeout tunnel <timeout>
8523 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 yes | no | yes | yes
8526 Arguments :
8527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8529 as explained at the top of this document.
8530
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008531 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008532 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8533 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8534 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8535 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8536 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8537 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8538 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8539 specified.
8540
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008541 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8542 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8543 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8544 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8545 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8546 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8547 state.
8548
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008549 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8550 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8551 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8552 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8553 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8554
8555 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8556 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8557 forget about it.
8558
8559 Example :
8560 defaults http
8561 option http-server-close
8562 timeout connect 5s
8563 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008564 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008565 timeout server 30s
8566 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8567
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008568 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008569
8570
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008571transparent (deprecated)
8572 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008574 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008575 Arguments : none
8576
8577 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8578 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8579 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8580 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8581 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8582 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8583 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8584 appropriate server.
8585
8586 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8587
8588 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8589 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8590
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008591 See also: "option transparent"
8592
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008593unique-id-format <string>
8594 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8596 yes | yes | yes | no
8597 Arguments :
8598 <string> is a log-format string.
8599
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008600 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8601 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8602 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8603 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008604
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008605 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8606 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8607 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8608 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8609 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8610 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8611 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8612 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008613
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008614 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8615 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008617 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008618
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008619 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008620
8621 will generate:
8622
8623 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8624
8625 See also: "unique-id-header"
8626
8627unique-id-header <name>
8628 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 yes | yes | yes | no
8631 Arguments :
8632 <name> is the name of the header.
8633
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008634 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8635 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008637 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008638
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008639 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008640 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8641
8642 will generate:
8643
8644 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8645
8646 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008647
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008648use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008649 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8651 no | yes | yes | no
8652 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008653 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8654 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008655
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008656 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8657 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008658
8659 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8660 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8661 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008662 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8663 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8664 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8665 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008666
8667 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8668 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8669 assign the backend.
8670
8671 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8672 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8673 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8674 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8675 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8676 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8677
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008678 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008679 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008680 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8681 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8682 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8683
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008684 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8685 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8686 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8687 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8688 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8689 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8690 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8691 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8692 cannot be forced from the request.
8693
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008694 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008695 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8696 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8697
8698 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8699 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008700
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008701
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008702use-server <server> if <condition>
8703use-server <server> unless <condition>
8704 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8706 no | no | yes | yes
8707 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008708 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008709
8710 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8711
8712 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8713 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8714 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8715
8716 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8717 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8718 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8719 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8720 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8721 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8722 matches will assign the server.
8723
8724 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8725 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8726 with the next rules until one matches.
8727
8728 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8729 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8730 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8731 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8732
8733 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8734 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8735 stripped.
8736
8737 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8738 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8739 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8740 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8741
8742 Example :
8743 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8744 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8745 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8746 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8747 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8748 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8749 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8750 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8751 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8752
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008753 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008754
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008755
87565. Bind and Server options
8757--------------------------
8758
8759The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8760depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8761settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8762written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8763described in this section.
8764
8765
87665.1. Bind options
8767-----------------
8768
8769The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8770as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8771no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8772parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8773while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8774provided immediately after the setting name.
8775
8776The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8777
8778accept-proxy
8779 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008780 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8781 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008782 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8783 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8784 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8785 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8786 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8787 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8788 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008789 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8790 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008791
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008792alpn <protocols>
8793 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8794 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8795 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8796 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8797 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8798 initial NPN extension.
8799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008800backlog <backlog>
8801 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8802 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8803
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008804ecdhe <named curve>
8805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008806 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8807 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008808
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008809ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8811 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8812 client's certificate.
8813
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008814ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8816 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8817 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8818 error is ignored.
8819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008820ciphers <ciphers>
8821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8822 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008823 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008824 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8825 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8826
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008827crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8829 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8830 to verify client's certificate.
8831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008832crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8834 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8835 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8836 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8837 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8838 file.
8839
8840 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8841 are loaded.
8842
8843 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008844 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008845 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8846 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8847 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8848 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8849 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8850 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8851 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008852
8853 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8854 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8855 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8856 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008857 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8858 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008859
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008860 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008861
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008862 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8863 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008864 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008865 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8866 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8867 clients).
8868
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008869 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8870 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8871 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8872 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8873 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8874 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8875 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8876 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8877 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8878 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8879 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8880 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8881 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8882
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008883 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8884 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
8885 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
8886 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
8887 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
8888
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008889crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8891 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008892 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008893 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008894
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008895crt-list <file>
8896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008897 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8898 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008899
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008900 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008901
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008902 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8903 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8904 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8905 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8906 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8907 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8908 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8909 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008910
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008911defer-accept
8912 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8913 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8914 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8915 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8916 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8917 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8918 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8919 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8920 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8921 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8922 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8923
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008924force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008925 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008926 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008927 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8928 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008929
8930force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008931 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008932 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8933 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008934
8935force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008936 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008937 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8938 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008939
8940force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008941 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008942 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8943 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008945gid <gid>
8946 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8947 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8948 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8949 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8950 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8951
8952group <group>
8953 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8954 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8955 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8956 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8957 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8958
8959id <id>
8960 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8961 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8962 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8963 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8964
8965interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008966 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8967 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8968 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8969 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8970 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8971 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8972 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008973
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008974level <level>
8975 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8976 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8977 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8978 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8979 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8980 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8981 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8982 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8983 counters).
8984 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8985 all counters).
8986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008987maxconn <maxconn>
8988 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8989 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8990 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8991 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8992 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8993 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8994 eat all memory.
8995
8996mode <mode>
8997 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8998 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8999 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9000 UNIX sockets.
9001
9002mss <maxseg>
9003 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9004 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9005 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9006 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9007 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9008 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9009 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9010 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9011 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9012 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9013 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9014
9015name <name>
9016 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9017 page.
9018
9019nice <nice>
9020 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9021 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9022 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9023 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9024 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9025 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9026 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9027 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9028 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9029 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9030 one for an RDP socket.
9031
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009032no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009034 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009035 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009036 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9037 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009038 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009039
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009040no-tls-tickets
9041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9042 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9043 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009044 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9045 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009046
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009047no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009049 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009050 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009051 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9052 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9053 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009054
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009055no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009056 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009057 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009058 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009059 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9060 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9061 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009062
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009063no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009065 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009066 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009067 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9068 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9069 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009070
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009071npn <protocols>
9072 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9073 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9074 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9075 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009076 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9077 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009078
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009079process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9080 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9081 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9082 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9083 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9084 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9085 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9086 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009087 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9088 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9089 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9090 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9091 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9092 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9093 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009095ssl
9096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009097 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009098 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9099 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9100 to deciphered contents.
9101
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009102strict-sni
9103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9104 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9105 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9106 See the "crt" option for more information.
9107
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009108tcp-ut <delay>
9109 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9110 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9111 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9112 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9113 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9114 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9115 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9116 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9117 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9118 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9119 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9120
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009121tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009122 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009123 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9124 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9125 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9126 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9127 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9128 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9129 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009130 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9131 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9132 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009133
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009134tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9135 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9136 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9137 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9138 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9139 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9140 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9141 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9142 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9143 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9144 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009146transparent
9147 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9148 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9149 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9150 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9151 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9152 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9153 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9154 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9155 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9156 so check for support with your vendor.
9157
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009158v4v6
9159 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9160 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9161 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9162 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009163 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009164
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009165v6only
9166 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9167 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9168 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009169 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9170 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009172uid <uid>
9173 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9174 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9175 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9176 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9177 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9178
9179user <user>
9180 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9181 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9182 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9183 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9184 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9185
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009186verify [none|optional|required]
9187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9188 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9189 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9190 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9191 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009192 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9193 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9194 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9195 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020091975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009198------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009200The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9201which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9202arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9203settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9204after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9205Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9206address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009208 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009209 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009211The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009212
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009213addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009214 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9215 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9216 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9217 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9218 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009220 Supported in default-server: No
9221
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009222agent-check
9223 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009224 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9225 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9226 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9227 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009228
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009229 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009230 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009231 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9232 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9233 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009234
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009235 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9236 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009237
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009238 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9239 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9240 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009241
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009242 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9243 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9244 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009245
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009246 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9247 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9248 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9249 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9250 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9251 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9252 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009253
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009254 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9255 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009256
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009257 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9258 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9259 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9260 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9261 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9262 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9263 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9264 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9265 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009266
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009267 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9268 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009269 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9270 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9271 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9272 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009273
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009274 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9275 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009276
9277 Supported in default-server: No
9278
9279agent-inter <delay>
9280 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9281 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9282
9283 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9284 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9285 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9286 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9287 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9288 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9289 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9290 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9291 of backends use the same servers.
9292
9293 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9294
9295 Supported in default-server: Yes
9296
9297agent-port <port>
9298 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9299
9300 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9301
9302 Supported in default-server: Yes
9303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009304backup
9305 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9306 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9307 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9308 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9309 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9310 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009312 Supported in default-server: No
9313
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009314ca-file <cafile>
9315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9316 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9317 server's certificate.
9318
9319 Supported in default-server: No
9320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009321check
9322 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009323 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9324 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9325 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9326 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9327 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9328 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9329 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009330 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9331 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9332 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009334 Supported in default-server: No
9335
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009336check-send-proxy
9337 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9338 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9339 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9340 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9341 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9342 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9343 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9344
9345 Supported in default-server: No
9346
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009347check-ssl
9348 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9349 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9350 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9351 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009352 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009353 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9354 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9355 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9356 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9357
9358 Supported in default-server: No
9359
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009360ciphers <ciphers>
9361 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009362 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009363 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9364 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9365 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9366 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9367 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9368 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9369
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009370 Supported in default-server: No
9371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009372cookie <value>
9373 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9374 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9375 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9376 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9377 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9378 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9379 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009381 Supported in default-server: No
9382
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009383crl-file <crlfile>
9384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9385 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9386 to verify server's certificate.
9387
9388 Supported in default-server: No
9389
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009390crt <cert>
9391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9392 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9393 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9394 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9395 certificate request.
9396
9397 Supported in default-server: No
9398
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009399disabled
9400 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9401 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9402 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9403 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9404 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9405
9406 Supported in default-server: No
9407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009408error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009409 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9410 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9411 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009413 Supported in default-server: Yes
9414
9415 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009417fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009418 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9419 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9420 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009422 Supported in default-server: Yes
9423
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009424force-sslv3
9425 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9426 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009427 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9428 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009429
9430 Supported in default-server: No
9431
9432force-tlsv10
9433 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009434 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9435 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009436
9437 Supported in default-server: No
9438
9439force-tlsv11
9440 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009441 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9442 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009443
9444 Supported in default-server: No
9445
9446force-tlsv12
9447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009448 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9449 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009450
9451 Supported in default-server: No
9452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009453id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009454 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9455 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9456 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009458 Supported in default-server: No
9459
9460inter <delay>
9461fastinter <delay>
9462downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009463 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9464 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9465 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9466 between checks depending on the server state :
9467
9468 Server state | Interval used
9469 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9470 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9471 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9472 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9473 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9474 or yet unchecked. |
9475 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9476 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9477 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009479 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9480 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9481 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9482 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009483 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9484 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9485 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9486 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9487 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009489 Supported in default-server: Yes
9490
9491maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009492 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9493 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9494 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9495 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9496 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9497 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9498 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9499 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009501 Supported in default-server: Yes
9502
9503maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009504 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9505 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9506 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9507 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9508 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9509 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9510 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009512 Supported in default-server: Yes
9513
9514minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009515 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9516 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9517 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9518 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9519 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9520 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009521 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009522 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009524 Supported in default-server: Yes
9525
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009526no-ssl-reuse
9527 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9528 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9529 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9530 and for paranoid users.
9531
9532 Supported in default-server: No
9533
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009534no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009535 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9536 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009537 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009538
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009539 Supported in default-server: No
9540
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009541no-tls-tickets
9542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9543 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9544 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009545 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9546 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009547
9548 Supported in default-server: No
9549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009550no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009551 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9553 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009554 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9555 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9556 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009557
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009558 Supported in default-server: No
9559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009560no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009561 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9563 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009564 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9565 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9566 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009567
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009568 Supported in default-server: No
9569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009570no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009571 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9576 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009577
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009578 Supported in default-server: No
9579
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009580non-stick
9581 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9582 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9583 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9584
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009585 Supported in default-server: No
9586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009587observe <mode>
9588 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9589 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9590 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9591 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9592 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9593 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009594 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009596 Supported in default-server: No
9597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009598 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009600on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009601 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9602 Currently, four modes are available:
9603 - fastinter: force fastinter
9604 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9605 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9606 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9607 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009609 Supported in default-server: Yes
9610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009611 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9612
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009613on-marked-down <action>
9614 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9615 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009616 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9617 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9618 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9619 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9620 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9621 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9622 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9623 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009624
9625 Actions are disabled by default
9626
9627 Supported in default-server: Yes
9628
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009629on-marked-up <action>
9630 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9631 Currently one action is available:
9632 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9633 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9634 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9635 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9636 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9637 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9638 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9639 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9640
9641 Actions are disabled by default
9642
9643 Supported in default-server: Yes
9644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009645port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009646 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9647 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9648 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9649 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9650 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9651 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009653 Supported in default-server: Yes
9654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009655redir <prefix>
9656 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9657 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9658 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9659 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9660 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9661 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9662 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9663 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009664 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009665 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9666 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9667 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9668 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9669 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9670
9671 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009673 Supported in default-server: No
9674
9675rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009676 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9677 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9678 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009680 Supported in default-server: Yes
9681
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009682send-proxy
9683 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9684 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9685 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9686 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9687 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9688 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9689 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9690 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9691 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009692 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9693 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9694 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9695 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9696 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009697
9698 Supported in default-server: No
9699
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009700send-proxy-v2
9701 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9702 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9703 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9704 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9705 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9706 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9707 option of the "bind" keyword.
9708
9709 Supported in default-server: No
9710
9711send-proxy-v2-ssl
9712 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9713 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9714 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9715 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9716 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9717 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9718 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9719 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9720
9721 Supported in default-server: No
9722
9723send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9724 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9725 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9726 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9727 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9728 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9729 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9730 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9731 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9732 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9733
9734 Supported in default-server: No
9735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009736slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009737 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9738 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9739 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9740 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9741 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9742 parameters :
9743
9744 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9745 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9746
9747 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9748 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9749 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9750 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9751
9752 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9753 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9754 seen as failed.
9755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009756 Supported in default-server: Yes
9757
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009758source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009759source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009760source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009761 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9762 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9763 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9764 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9765
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009766 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9767 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9768 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9769 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9770 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9771 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9772 server.
9773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009774 Supported in default-server: No
9775
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009776ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009777 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9778 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9779 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9780 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9781 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9782 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009783 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009784
9785 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009787track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009788 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9789 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9790 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9791 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009792 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009794 Supported in default-server: No
9795
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009796verify [none|required]
9797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009798 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9799 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9800 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9801 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009802 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9803 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9804 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009805
9806 Supported in default-server: No
9807
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009808verifyhost <hostname>
9809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9810 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9811 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9812 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9813 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9814 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9815
9816 Supported in default-server: No
9817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009818weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009819 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9820 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9821 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009822 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9823 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9824 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9825 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9826 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9827 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009829 Supported in default-server: Yes
9830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009831
98326. HTTP header manipulation
9833---------------------------
9834
9835In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9836response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9837request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9838which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009839against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009840
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009841If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9842to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9843but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9844HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9845stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9846because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9847a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9848still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009850This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9851in section 4.2 :
9852
9853 - reqadd <string>
9854 - reqallow <search>
9855 - reqiallow <search>
9856 - reqdel <search>
9857 - reqidel <search>
9858 - reqdeny <search>
9859 - reqideny <search>
9860 - reqpass <search>
9861 - reqipass <search>
9862 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9863 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9864 - reqtarpit <search>
9865 - reqitarpit <search>
9866 - rspadd <string>
9867 - rspdel <search>
9868 - rspidel <search>
9869 - rspdeny <search>
9870 - rspideny <search>
9871 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9872 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9873
9874With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9875is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9876parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9877prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9878Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9879
9880 \t for a tab
9881 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9882 \n for a new line (LF)
9883 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9884 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9885 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9886 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9887 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9888
9889The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9890portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9891above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9892regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
98939 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9894is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9895
9896The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9897after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9898
9899Notes related to these keywords :
9900---------------------------------
9901 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9902 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9903 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9904
9905 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9906 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9907 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9908
9909 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9910 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9911 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9912 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9913 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9914
9915 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9916 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9917 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9918 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9919 useless headers before adding new ones.
9920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009921 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009922 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9923
9924 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9925 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9926 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9927
9928 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9929 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009930 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009931
9932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099337. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9934----------------------------------
9935
9936Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9937client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9938The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9939these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9940but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9941data called patterns.
9942
9943
99447.1. ACL basics
9945---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009946
9947The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9948content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9949from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9950simple :
9951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009953 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009954 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9955 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009957The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9958adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009959
9960In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009962 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009963
9964This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9965Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9966and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009967an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9968conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9969as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9970are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009971
9972ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9973'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9974which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9975
9976There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9977performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9980specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9981this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009982methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9983ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984
9985Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9986 - boolean
9987 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9988 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9989 - string
9990 - data block
9991
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009992Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9993converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9994would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9995The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9996which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9997
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009998Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9999keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10000fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10001which are summarized in the table below :
10002
10003 +---------------------+-----------------+
10004 | Sample or converter | Default |
10005 | output type | matching method |
10006 +---------------------+-----------------+
10007 | boolean | bool |
10008 +---------------------+-----------------+
10009 | integer | int |
10010 +---------------------+-----------------+
10011 | ip | ip |
10012 +---------------------+-----------------+
10013 | string | str |
10014 +---------------------+-----------------+
10015 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10016 +---------------------+-----------------+
10017
10018Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10019matching method, see below.
10020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010021The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10022 - boolean
10023 - integer or integer range
10024 - IP address / network
10025 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10026 - regular expression
10027 - hex block
10028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010029The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10030
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010031 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10032 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010033 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010034 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010035 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010036 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010037 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010039The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10040read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10041if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10042lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10043will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10044beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10045a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10046lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10047exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10048
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010049The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10050parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10051ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10052a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10053check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10054
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010055The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10056socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10057file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10060loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10061
10062 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10063
10064In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10065the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10066case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10067as well.
10068
10069The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10070sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10071do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10072methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10073is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10074obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10075followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10076default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10077that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10078string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10079
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010080The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10081By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10082string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10083resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10084server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10085waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10086flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10087function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010089There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10090sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10091be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010092
10093 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10094 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010095 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10096 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10097 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10098 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010099
10100 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10101 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010103
10104 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010106
10107 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010109
10110 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10111 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10112
10113 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10114 binary or string samples.
10115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010116 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10117 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010119 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10120 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10121 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10124 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10127 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10130 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10133 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010134 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010136 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10137 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10138 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010139
10140For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10141request, it is possible to do :
10142
10143 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10144
10145In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10146buffer, one would use the following acl :
10147
10148 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10149
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010150On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10151possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10152
10153 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10156criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10157method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10158to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10159criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10160the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010163the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10164For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010166 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10167 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10168 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10169 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010170
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010171
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010172The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10173types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10174combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10175brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10176default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010178 +-------------------------------------------------+
10179 | Input sample type |
10180 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010181 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10183 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10184 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010185 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010187 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010189 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010191 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010193 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010195 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010196 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010197 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010199 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010201 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010202 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010203 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010205 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10207 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10208 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010209
10210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102117.1.1. Matching booleans
10212------------------------
10213
10214In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10215Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10216When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10217that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10218
10219Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10220return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10221"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10222
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102247.1.2. Matching integers
10225------------------------
10226
10227Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10228enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10229to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10230
10231Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10232matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10233lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010234
10235For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10236unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10237representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10238
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010239As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10240two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10241instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10242ranges and operators.
10243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010244For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010245operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10246Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10247of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010249Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010250
10251 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10252 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10253 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10254 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10255 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010257For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010258
10259 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10260
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010261This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10262
10263 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102667.1.3. Matching strings
10267-----------------------
10268
10269String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10270different forms :
10271
10272 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10273 patterns ;
10274
10275 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10276 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10277
10278 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10279 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10280
10281 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10282 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10283
10284 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10285 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10286 matches.
10287
10288 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10289 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10290 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010291
10292String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10293exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10294characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10295string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10296to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010297before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010298
10299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103007.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10301---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010302
10303Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10304they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10305possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10306passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10307the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010308the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10309match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010310
10311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103127.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10313-------------------------------------
10314
10315It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10316not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10317a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10318to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10319digits may be used upper or lower case.
10320
10321Example :
10322 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10323 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10324
10325
103267.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10327---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010328
10329IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10330netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10331within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010332host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010333difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10334at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10335does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10336parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010337
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010338IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10339Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10340trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10341IPv6 patterns.
10342
10343HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10344following situations :
10345 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10346 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10347 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10348 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10349 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10350 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10351 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10352 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10353 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10354 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010356
103577.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10358----------------------------------
10359
10360Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10361combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10362
10363 - AND (implicit)
10364 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10365 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010367A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010369 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010371Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10372indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010374For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10375"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10376requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10377is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10378
10379 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10380 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10381 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10382 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10383
10384To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10385and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10386
10387 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10388 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10389 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10390 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10391
10392 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10393 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10394 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10395 use_backend www if host_www
10396
10397It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10398expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10399be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10400the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10401
10402 The following rule :
10403
10404 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10405 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10406
10407 Can also be written that way :
10408
10409 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10410
10411It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10412to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10413simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10414sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10415good use is the following :
10416
10417 With named ACLs :
10418
10419 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10420 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10421 monitor fail if site_dead
10422
10423 With anonymous ACLs :
10424
10425 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10426
10427See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10428
10429
104307.3. Fetching samples
10431---------------------
10432
10433Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10434against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10435sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10436ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10437of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10438available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10439
10440This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10441Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10442compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10443deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10444
10445The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10446matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10447method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10448indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10449
10450As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10451when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10452mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10453the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10454ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10455
10456Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10457multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10458when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10459incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10460are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10461is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10462all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10463
10464Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10465 - name
10466 - name(arg1)
10467 - name(arg1,arg2)
10468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010469
104707.3.1. Converters
10471-----------------
10472
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010473Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10474of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10475is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10476was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10477has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10478unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10479
10480These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10481sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10482the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10483support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010484
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010485A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10486support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10487supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10488(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10489bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010491The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010492
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010493add(<value>)
10494 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10495 result as an unsigned integer.
10496
10497and(<value>)
10498 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10499 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10500
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010501base64
10502 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10503 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10504 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10505
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010506bool
10507 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10508 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10509 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10510 presence of a flag).
10511
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010512bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10513 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10514 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10515 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10516
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010517cpl
10518 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10519 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10520
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010521crc32([<avalanche>])
10522 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10523 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10524 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10525 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10526 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10527 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10528 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10529 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10530 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10531 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10532 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10533
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010534div(<value>)
10535 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10536 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10537 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10538
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010539djb2([<avalanche>])
10540 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10541 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10542 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10543 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10544 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10545 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10546 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010547 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10548 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010549
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010550even
10551 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10552 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10553
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010554field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10555 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10556 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10557 list of chars.
10558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010559hex
10560 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10561 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10562 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10563 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010565http_date([<offset>])
10566 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10567 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10568 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10569 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10570 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10571 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010573in_table(<table>)
10574 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10575 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10576 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10577 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10578 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10579
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010580ipmask(<mask>)
10581 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10582 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10583 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10584 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10585
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010586json([<input-code>])
10587 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10588 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10589 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10590 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10591 of errors:
10592 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10593 bytes, ...)
10594 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10595 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10596
10597 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10598 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10599 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10600 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10601 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10602 are :
10603 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10604 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10605 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10606 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10607 error ;
10608 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10609 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10610
10611 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10612 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10613
10614 Example:
10615 capture request header user-agent len 150
10616 capture request header Host len 15
10617 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10618
10619 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10620 GET / HTTP/1.0
10621 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10622
10623 Output log:
10624 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010626language(<value>[,<default>])
10627 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10628 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10629 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10630 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10631 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10632 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10633 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10634 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10635 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10636 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10637 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10638 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010639
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010640 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010642 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10643 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010645 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10646 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10647 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10648 use_backend spanish if es
10649 use_backend french if fr
10650 use_backend english if en
10651 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010652
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010653lower
10654 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10655 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10656 type. The result is of type string.
10657
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010658ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10659 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10660 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10661 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10662 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10663 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10664 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10665
10666 Example :
10667
10668 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10669 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10670 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10671
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010672map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10673map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10674map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10675 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10676 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10677 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10678 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10679 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10680 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10681 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10682 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010683
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010684 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10685 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10686 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010687
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010688 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10689 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010690
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010691 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10692 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10693 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10694 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010695 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10696 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010697 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10698 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10699 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10700 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10701 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10702 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10703 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10704 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10705 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10706 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10707 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10708 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10709 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10710 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010711
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010712 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10713 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10714 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10715 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10716 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010717
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010718 Example :
10719
10720 # this is a comment and is ignored
10721 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10722 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10723 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10724 | | | `---------- value
10725 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10726 | `---------------------------- key
10727 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10728
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010729mod(<value>)
10730 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10731 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10732
10733mul(<value>)
10734 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10735 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10736 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10737
10738neg
10739 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10740 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10741 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10742 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10743
10744not
10745 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10746 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10747 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10748 absence of a flag).
10749
10750odd
10751 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10752 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10753
10754or(<value>)
10755 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10756 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10757
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010758regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010759 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10760 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10761 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10762 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10763 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10764 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10765 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10766 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10767 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10768 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10769 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10770 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10771 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10772
10773 Example :
10774
10775 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10776 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10777 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10778 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10779
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010780sdbm([<avalanche>])
10781 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10782 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10783 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10784 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10785 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10786 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10787 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010788 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10789 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010790
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010791sub(<value>)
10792 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10793 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10794 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10795
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010796table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10800 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10801 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10802 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10803
10804
10805table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10809 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10810 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10811 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10812
10813table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10817 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10818 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10819
10820table_conn_cur(<table>)
10821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10824 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10825 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10826
10827table_conn_rate(<table>)
10828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10831 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10832 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10833
10834table_gpc0(<table>)
10835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10838 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10839 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10840
10841table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10845 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10846 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10847 sample fetch keyword.
10848
10849table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10850 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10851 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10852 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10853 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10854 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10855
10856table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10859 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10860 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10861 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10862 keyword.
10863
10864table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10868 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10869 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10870
10871table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10874 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10875 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10876 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10877 keyword.
10878
10879table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10883 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10884 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10885 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10886 keyword.
10887
10888table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10892 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10893 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10894 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10895 keyword.
10896
10897table_server_id(<table>)
10898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10900 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10901 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10902 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10903 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10904
10905table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10909 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10910 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10911 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10912 keyword.
10913
10914table_sess_rate(<table>)
10915 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10916 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10917 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10918 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10919 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10920 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10921 keyword.
10922
10923table_trackers(<table>)
10924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10927 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10928 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10929 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10930 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10931 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10932 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10933 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10934
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010935upper
10936 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10937 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10938 type. The result is of type string.
10939
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010940utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10941 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10942 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10943 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10944 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10945 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10946 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10947
10948 Example :
10949
10950 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10951 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10952 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10953
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010954word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10955 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10956 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10957
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010958wt6([<avalanche>])
10959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10960 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10961 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10962 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10963 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10964 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10965 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010966 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10967 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010968
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010969xor(<value>)
10970 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10971 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10972
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010973
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109747.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010975--------------------------------------------
10976
10977A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10978not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10979"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10980The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10981
10982always_false : boolean
10983 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10984 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10985
10986always_true : boolean
10987 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10988 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10989
10990avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010991 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10993 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10994 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10995 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10996 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10997 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10998 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10999 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11000 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11001 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11002 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11003 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11004 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011007 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11008 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11009 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11010 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11011 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011013be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11014 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11015 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11016 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11017 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11018 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11019 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011020
11021 Example :
11022 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11023 backend dynamic
11024 mode http
11025 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11026 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11029 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011030 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11032 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011033
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011034 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011035 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011036 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11037
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011038 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11039 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011040
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011041 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011042 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011044 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11045 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011047 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011048
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011049 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11050 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011052 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011053
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011054date([<offset>]) : integer
11055 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11056 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11057 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11058 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011059 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11060
11061 Example :
11062
11063 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11064 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011065
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011066env(<name>) : string
11067 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11068 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11069 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11070 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11071 certain way.
11072
11073 Examples :
11074 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11075 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11076
11077 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11078 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11081 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011082 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11083 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11085 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11086 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11087 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11088 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11091 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11092 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11093 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11094 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11095 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11096 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11097 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11098 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011099
11100 Example :
11101 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11102 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11103 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11104 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11105 frontend mail
11106 bind :25
11107 mode tcp
11108 maxconn 100
11109 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11110 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11111 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11112 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011113
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011114nbproc : integer
11115 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11116 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11117 and debugging purposes.
11118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011119nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11121 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11122 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011123 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11124 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11125 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011126
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011127proc : integer
11128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11129 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11130 debugging purposes.
11131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011133 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11134 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11135 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11137 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11138 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11139 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11140 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11141
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011142rand([<range>]) : integer
11143 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11144 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11145 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11146 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11147 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011149srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11150 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11151 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11152 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11153 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11154 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11155 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11156 methods.
11157
11158srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11159 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11160 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11161 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11162 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11163 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11164 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11165 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11166
11167srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11168 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11169 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011170 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11172 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11173 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11174 overloading servers).
11175
11176 Example :
11177 # Redirect to a separate back
11178 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11179 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11180 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11181
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011182stopping : boolean
11183 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11184 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11185 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11188 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11189 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11190
11191table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11192 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11194 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11195
11196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111977.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198----------------------------------
11199
11200The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11201closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11202methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11203sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11204TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011205the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11206counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11207"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011208argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11209the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11210this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011211
11212be_id : integer
11213 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11214 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11215
11216dst : ip
11217 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11218 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11219 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11220 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11221 RFC 4291.
11222
11223dst_conn : integer
11224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11225 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11226 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11227 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11228 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11229 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11230 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11231 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233dst_port : integer
11234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11235 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11236 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11237 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11238 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11239 an HTTP header.
11240
11241fe_id : integer
11242 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11243 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11244 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11245
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011246sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011247sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11248sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11249sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011250 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11251 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11252 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011254sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011255sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11256sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11257sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011258 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11259 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11260 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11261
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011262sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011263sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11264sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11265sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011266 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11267 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011268 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11269 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11270 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011271
11272 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11273 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011274 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11275 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11276 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011277 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11278 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011280sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011281sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11282sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11283sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011284 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11285 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11286
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011287sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011288sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11289sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11290sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011291 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11292 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11293 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011295sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011296sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11297sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11298sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011299 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11300 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11301 See also src_conn_rate.
11302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011303sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011304sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11305sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11306sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011307 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011308 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011310sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011311sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11312sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11313sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011314 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11315 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11316 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011317 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11318 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11319 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011321sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011322sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11323sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11324sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011325 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11326 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11327 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11328
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011329sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011330sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11331sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11332sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011333 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11334 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11335 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11336 src_http_err_rate.
11337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011338sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011339sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11340sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11341sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011342 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11343 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11344 src_http_req_cnt.
11345
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011346sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011347sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11348sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11349sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011350 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11351 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11352 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11353 src_http_req_rate.
11354
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011355sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011356sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11357sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11358sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011359 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011360 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11361 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11362 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11363 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011364
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011365 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11366 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011367 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011369sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011370sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11371sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11372sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011373 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11374 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11375 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011377sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011378sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11379sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11380sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011381 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11382 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11383 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011385sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011386sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11387sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11388sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011389 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11390 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11391 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11392 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011393 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011394 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011396sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011397sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11398sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11399sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011400 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11401 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11402 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11403 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11404 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011405 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011406
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011407sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011408sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11409sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11410sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011411 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11412 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11413 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11414
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011415sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011416sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11417sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11418sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011419 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11420 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011421 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011422 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11423 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011424 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11425 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11426 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011428so_id : integer
11429 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11430 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11431 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433src : ip
11434 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11435 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11436 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11437 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11438 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11439 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11440 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011441
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011442 Example:
11443 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11444 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11447 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11448 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11449 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011450 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011452src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11453 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11454 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011455 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011456 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011458src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11459 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11460 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11461 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11462 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11463 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11464 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011465
11466 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11467 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11468 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11469 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011470 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011471 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11472 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011475 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011476 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011477 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011478 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011481 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011482 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11483 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011484 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011486src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11487 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11488 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11489 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011490 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011493 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011495 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011496 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011499 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011501 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11502 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011503 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11504 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11505 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11508 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11509 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011510 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011511 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011514src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11515 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11516 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11517 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11518 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011519 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11522 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11523 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11524 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011525 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11528 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11529 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11530 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011531 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011532 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011534src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11535 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11536 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11537 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011538 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011539 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11540 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011541
11542 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011543 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011544 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011547 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11548 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11549 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11550 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11551 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011553src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011554 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11555 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11556 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11557 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11558 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560src_port : integer
11561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11562 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11563 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11564 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011566src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11567 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011568 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11569 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11570 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011571 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011573src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11574 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11575 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11576 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11577 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011578 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011580src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11581 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11582 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11583 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11584 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11585 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11586 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11587 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11588 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011589
11590 Example :
11591 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11592 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11593 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11594 listen ssh
11595 bind :22
11596 mode tcp
11597 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011598 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011600 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011602srv_id : integer
11603 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11604 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11605 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011606
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011607
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116087.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011609----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011611The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11612closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11613when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11614usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011615future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011616
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011617ssl_bc : boolean
11618 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11619 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11620 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11621
11622ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11623 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11624 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11625
11626ssl_bc_cipher : string
11627 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11628 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11629
11630ssl_bc_protocol : string
11631 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11632 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11633
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011634ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011635 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011636 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11637 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011638
11639ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11640 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11641 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11642 if session was reused or not.
11643
11644ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11645 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11646 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011648ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11649 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11650 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11651 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11652 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11653 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11656 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11657 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11658 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11659 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011660
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011661ssl_c_der : binary
11662 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11663 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11664 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011666ssl_c_err : integer
11667 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11668 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11669 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11670 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11671 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011673ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11674 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11675 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11676 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11677 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11678 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11679 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11680 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11681 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011683ssl_c_key_alg : string
11684 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11685 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11686 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688ssl_c_notafter : string
11689 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11690 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11691 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011693ssl_c_notbefore : string
11694 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11695 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11696 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011698ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11699 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11700 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11701 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11702 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11703 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11704 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11705 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11706 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011708ssl_c_serial : binary
11709 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11710 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11711 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11714 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11715 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11716 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011717 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11718 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11719
11720 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11723 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11724 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11725 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011727ssl_c_used : boolean
11728 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11729 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011731ssl_c_verify : integer
11732 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11733 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11734 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11735 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011737ssl_c_version : integer
11738 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11739 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011740
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011741ssl_f_der : binary
11742 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11743 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11744 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011746ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11747 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11748 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11749 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11750 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011751 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11753 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11754 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756ssl_f_key_alg : string
11757 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11758 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11759 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011761ssl_f_notafter : string
11762 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11763 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11764 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011766ssl_f_notbefore : string
11767 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11768 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11769 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011771ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11772 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11773 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11774 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11775 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11776 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11777 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11778 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11779 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781ssl_f_serial : binary
11782 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11783 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11784 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011785
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011786ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11787 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11788 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11789 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11792 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11793 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11794 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796ssl_f_version : integer
11797 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11798 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11799
11800ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011801 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11802 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11803 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011805 Example :
11806 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11807 listen http-https
11808 bind :80
11809 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11810 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11811
11812ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11813 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11814 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11815
11816ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011817 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011818 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11819 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11820 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11821 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11822 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11823 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11824 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11825 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011827ssl_fc_cipher : string
11828 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11829 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011831ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011832 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11833 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011834 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11835 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11836 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11837 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011839ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11840 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011841 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11842 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11843 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11844 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011846ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011847 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11849 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11850 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11851 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11852 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11853 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11854 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856ssl_fc_protocol : string
11857 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11858 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011859
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011860ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011862 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11863 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011865ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11866 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11867 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11868 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11869 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871ssl_fc_sni : string
11872 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11873 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11874 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11875 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11876 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11877
11878 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11879 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11880 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011881 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11882 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011885 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11886 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011888ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11889 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11890 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011891
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011892
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118937.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011894------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011896Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11897sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11898only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11899For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11900be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11901can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11902sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11903for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11904content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011906payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11907 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11908 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11909 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011911payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11912 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11913 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11914 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011916req.len : integer
11917req_len : integer (deprecated)
11918 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11919 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11920 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11921 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11922 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11923 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11924 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11925 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011927req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11928 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011929 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11930 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11931 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11932 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934 ACL alternatives :
11935 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011937req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11938 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11939 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11940 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11941 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011943 ACL alternatives :
11944 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011948req.proto_http : boolean
11949req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11950 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11951 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11952 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11953 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11954 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11955 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11956 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958 Example:
11959 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11960 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11961 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011962 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011964req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11965rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11966 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11967 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11968 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11969 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11970 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11971 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11972 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011974 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11975 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11976 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11977 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11978 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11979 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011981 ACL derivatives :
11982 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011984 Example :
11985 listen tse-farm
11986 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11987 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11988 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11989 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11990 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11991 persist rdp-cookie
11992 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11993 # This is only useful makes sense if
11994 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11995 stick-table type string size 204800
11996 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11997 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11998 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012000 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12001 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12004rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12005 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12006 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12007 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12008 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012010 ACL derivatives :
12011 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012013req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12014req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12015 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12016 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12017 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12018 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12019 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12020 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12021 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023req.ssl_sni : string
12024req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12025 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12026 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12027 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12028 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12029 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12030 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12031 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12032 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12033 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12034 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12035 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12036 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012038 ACL derivatives :
12039 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041 Examples :
12042 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12043 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12044 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12045 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12046 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012048res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12049rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12050 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12051 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12052 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12053 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12054 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12055 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12056 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012058req.ssl_ver : integer
12059req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12060 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12061 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12062 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12063 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12064 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12065 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12066 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12067 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12068 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012070 ACL derivatives :
12071 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012072
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012073res.len : integer
12074 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12075 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12076 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12077 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12078 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12079 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12080 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12081 content inspection.
12082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12084 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012085 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12086 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12087 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12088 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012090res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12091 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12092 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12093 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12094 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012096 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012098wait_end : boolean
12099 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12100 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12101 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12102 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12103 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12104 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12105 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12106 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012108 Examples :
12109 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12110 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12111 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12114 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12115 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12116 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12117 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12118 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12119 tcp-request content reject
12120
12121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121227.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012123--------------------------------------
12124
12125It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12126This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12127data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12128its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12129HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12130content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12131to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12132more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12133response are indexed.
12134
12135base : string
12136 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12137 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12138 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12139 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12140 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12141 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12142 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12143 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12144
12145 ACL derivatives :
12146 base : exact string match
12147 base_beg : prefix match
12148 base_dir : subdir match
12149 base_dom : domain match
12150 base_end : suffix match
12151 base_len : length match
12152 base_reg : regex match
12153 base_sub : substring match
12154
12155base32 : integer
12156 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12157 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12158 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012159 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12160 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12161 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012162
12163base32+src : binary
12164 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12165 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12166 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12167 per-URL counters.
12168
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012169capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12170 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12171 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12172 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12173
12174capture.req.method : string
12175 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12176 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12177 because it's allocated.
12178
12179capture.req.uri : string
12180 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12181 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12182 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12183 allocated.
12184
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012185capture.req.ver : string
12186 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12187 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12188 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12189
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012190capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12191 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12192 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12193 The first entry is an index of 0.
12194 See also: "capture response header"
12195
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012196capture.res.ver : string
12197 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12198 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12199 persistent flag.
12200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012201req.cook([<name>]) : string
12202cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12203 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12204 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12205 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12206 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12207 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12208 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12209 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12210 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12211
12212 ACL derivatives :
12213 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12214 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12215 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12216 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12217 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12218 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12219 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12220 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012222req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12223cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12224 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12225 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12228cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12229 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12230 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12231 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12232 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012234cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12235 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12236 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12237 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12238 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12239 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12240 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12241 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12242 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12243 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12244 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012246hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12247 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12248 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12249 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12250 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012251 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012253req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12254 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12255 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12256 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12257 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12258 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12259 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12260 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12261 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012263req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12264 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12265 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12266 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12267 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012269req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12270 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12271 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12272 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12273 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12274 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12275 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12276 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12277 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12278 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12279 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12280 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282 ACL derivatives :
12283 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12284 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12285 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12286 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12287 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12288 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12289 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12290 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12291
12292req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12293hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12294 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12295 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12296 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12297 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12298 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12299 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12300 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12301 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12302 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12303
12304req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12305hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12306 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12307 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12308 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12309 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12310 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12311 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12312 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12313 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12314
12315req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12316hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12317 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12318 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12319 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12320 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12321 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12322 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12323 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12324
12325http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12326 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12327 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12328 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12329 basic auth is supported.
12330
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012331http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12332 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12333 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12334 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12335 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012336 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12337 basic auth is supported.
12338
12339 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012340 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12341 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12342 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12343 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012344
12345http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012346 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12347 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12349 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012351method : integer + string
12352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12353 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12354 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12355 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12356 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12357 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12358 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360 ACL derivatives :
12361 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363 Example :
12364 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12365 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12366 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012368path : string
12369 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12370 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12371 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12372 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12373 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12374 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12375 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012377 ACL derivatives :
12378 path : exact string match
12379 path_beg : prefix match
12380 path_dir : subdir match
12381 path_dom : domain match
12382 path_end : suffix match
12383 path_len : length match
12384 path_reg : regex match
12385 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012386
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012387query : string
12388 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12389 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12390 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12391 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12392 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12393 which stops before the question mark.
12394
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012395req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12396 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12397 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12398 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12399 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012401req.ver : string
12402req_ver : string (deprecated)
12403 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12404 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12405 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407 ACL derivatives :
12408 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012410res.comp : boolean
12411 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12412 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12413 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012415res.comp_algo : string
12416 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12417 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12418 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420res.cook([<name>]) : string
12421scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12422 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12423 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12424 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012426 ACL derivatives :
12427 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012429res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12430scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12431 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12432 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12433 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012435res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12436scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12437 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12438 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12439 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012441res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12442 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12443 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12444 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12445 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12446 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12447 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12448 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12449 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12450 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12453 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12454 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12455 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12456 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12457 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012459res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12460shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12461 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12462 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12463 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12464 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12465 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12466 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12467 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12468 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470 ACL derivatives :
12471 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12472 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12473 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12474 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12475 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12476 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12477 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12478 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12479
12480res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12481shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12482 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12483 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12484 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12485 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12486 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12489shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12490 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12491 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12492 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12493 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12494 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12495 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012496
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012497res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12498 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12499 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12500 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12501 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012503res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12504shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12505 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12506 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12507 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12508 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12509 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12510 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512res.ver : string
12513resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12514 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12515 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012517 ACL derivatives :
12518 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012520set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12521 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12522 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12523 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12524 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012526 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12527 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012529 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012531status : integer
12532 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12533 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12534 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012536url : string
12537 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12538 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12539 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12540 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12541 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12542 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12543 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545 ACL derivatives :
12546 url : exact string match
12547 url_beg : prefix match
12548 url_dir : subdir match
12549 url_dom : domain match
12550 url_end : suffix match
12551 url_len : length match
12552 url_reg : regex match
12553 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012555url_ip : ip
12556 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12557 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12558 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12559 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12560 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12561 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12562 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564url_port : integer
12565 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12566 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12567 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12568 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12571url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12572 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12573 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12574 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12575 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12576 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12577 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12578 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12579 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12580 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582 ACL derivatives :
12583 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12584 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12585 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12586 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12587 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12588 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12589 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12590 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012591
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012593 Example :
12594 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12595 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12596 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12597 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12600 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12601 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12602 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012603
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126057.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012606---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12609every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012610order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012612ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12613---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012614FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012615HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012616HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12617HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012618HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12619HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12620HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12621HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12622LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012623METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12624METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12625METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12626METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12627METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12628METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012629RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012630REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012631TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012632WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12633---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012634
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126368. Logging
12637----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012639One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12640provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12641very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12642provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12643state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012644to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012645headers.
12646
12647In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12648about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12649send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12650
12651 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12652 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12653 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12654 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12655 at the termination.
12656
12657The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12658allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12659as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12660while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12661real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12662delay.
12663
12664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126658.1. Log levels
12666---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012667
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012668TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012669source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012670HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12671in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12672track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12673syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12674about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012675
12676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126778.2. Log formats
12678----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012679
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012680HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012681and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12682slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12683options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012684
12685 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12686 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12687 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12688 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12689 extents.
12690
12691 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12692 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12693 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12694 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12695 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12696
12697 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12698 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12699 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12700 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12701 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12702
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012703 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12704 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12705 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12706 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12707
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012708 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12709
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012710Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12711specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12712field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12713servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12714always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12715identifier.
12716
12717Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12718 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12719 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12720 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12721 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12722
12723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127248.2.1. Default log format
12725-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012726
12727This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12728as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12729format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12730
12731 Example :
12732 listen www
12733 mode http
12734 log global
12735 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12736
12737 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12738 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12739 (www/HTTP)
12740
12741 Field Format Extract from the example above
12742 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12743 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12744 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12745 4 'to' to
12746 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12747 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12748
12749Detailed fields description :
12750 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12751 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12752 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12753 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12754 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12755 and processed the connection.
12756 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12757
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012758In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12759"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12760connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12761
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012762It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12763will eventually disappear.
12764
12765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127668.2.2. TCP log format
12767---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012768
12769The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12770is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12771information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12772counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12773emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12774environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12775the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12776sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012777specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12778not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12779fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12780marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012781
12782 Example :
12783 frontend fnt
12784 mode tcp
12785 option tcplog
12786 log global
12787 default_backend bck
12788
12789 backend bck
12790 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12791
12792 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12793 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12794 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12795
12796 Field Format Extract from the example above
12797 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12798 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12799 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12800 4 frontend_name fnt
12801 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12802 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12803 7 bytes_read* 212
12804 8 termination_state --
12805 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12806 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12807
12808Detailed fields description :
12809 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012810 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12811 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12812 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12813 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12814 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012815
12816 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012817 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12818 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12819 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012820
12821 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12822 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12823 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12824 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12825
12826 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12827 and processed the connection.
12828
12829 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12830 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12831 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12832 applications.
12833
12834 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12835 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12836 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12837 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12838 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12839
12840 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12841 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12842 See "Timers" below for more details.
12843
12844 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12845 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12846 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12847 "Timers" below for more details.
12848
12849 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012850 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012851 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12852 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12853 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12854 details.
12855
12856 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12857 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12858 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12859 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12860 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12861
12862 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12863 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12864 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12865 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12866 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12867 for more details.
12868
12869 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012870 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012871 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12872 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12873 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012874 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012875
12876 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12877 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12878 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12879 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12880 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12881 caused by a denial of service attack.
12882
12883 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12884 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12885 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12886 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12887 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12888 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12889 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12890 denial of service attack.
12891
12892 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12893 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12894 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12895 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12896 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12897 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12898 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12899 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12900 be processed than on other servers.
12901
12902 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12903 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12904 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12905 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12906 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12907 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12908 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12909 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12910 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12911 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12912 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12913 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12914 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12915
12916 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12917 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12918 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12919 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12920 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12921 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12922 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12923 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12924
12925 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12926 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12927 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12928 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12929 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12930 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12931 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12932 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12933 occurs.
12934
12935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129368.2.3. HTTP log format
12937----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012938
12939The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12940is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12941the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12942are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12943emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12944generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12945"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12946which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012947frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12948is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012949
12950Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12951slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12952with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12953
12954 Example :
12955 frontend http-in
12956 mode http
12957 option httplog
12958 log global
12959 default_backend bck
12960
12961 backend static
12962 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12963
12964 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12965 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12966 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012967 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012968
12969 Field Format Extract from the example above
12970 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12971 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12972 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12973 4 frontend_name http-in
12974 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12975 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12976 7 status_code 200
12977 8 bytes_read* 2750
12978 9 captured_request_cookie -
12979 10 captured_response_cookie -
12980 11 termination_state ----
12981 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12982 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12983 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12984 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12985 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012986
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012987
12988Detailed fields description :
12989 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012990 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12991 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12992 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12993 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12994 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012995
12996 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012997 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12998 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12999 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013000
13001 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13002 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13003 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13004 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13005 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13006
13007 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13008 and processed the connection.
13009
13010 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13011 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13012 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13013
13014 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13015 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13016 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13017 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13018 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13019 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13020
13021 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13022 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13023 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13024 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13025 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13026 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13027
13028 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13029 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13030 See "Timers" below for more details.
13031
13032 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13033 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13034 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13035 below for more details.
13036
13037 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13038 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13039 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13040 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13041 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13042 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13043 for more details.
13044
13045 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013046 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013047 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13048 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13049 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13050 details.
13051
13052 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13053 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13054 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13055
13056 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13057 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13058 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13059 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13060 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13061 overflowing.
13062
13063 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13064 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13065 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13066 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13067 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13068 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13069 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13070 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13071
13072 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13073 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13074 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13075 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13076 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13077 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13078 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13079 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13080
13081 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13082 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13083 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13084 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13085 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13086 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13087 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13088
13089 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013090 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013091 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13092 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13093 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013094 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013095 system.
13096
13097 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13098 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13099 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13100 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13101 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13102 caused by a denial of service attack.
13103
13104 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13105 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13106 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13107 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13108 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13109 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13110 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13111 denial of service attack.
13112
13113 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13114 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13115 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13116 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13117 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13118 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13119 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13120 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13121 processed than on other servers.
13122
13123 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13124 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13125 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13126 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13127 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13128 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13129 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13130 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13131 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13132 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13133 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13134 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13135 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13136
13137 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13138 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13139 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13140 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13141 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13142 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13143 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13144 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13145
13146 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13147 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13148 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13149 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13150 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13151 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13152 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13153 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13154 occurs.
13155
13156 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13157 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13158 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13159 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13160 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13161 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13162 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13163 cookies" below for more details.
13164
13165 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13166 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13167 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13168 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13169 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13170 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13171 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13172 and cookies" below for more details.
13173
13174 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13175 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13176 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13177 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13178 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13179 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13180 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13181 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13182
13183
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200131848.2.4. Custom log format
13185------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013186
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013187The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013188mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013189
13190HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13191Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13192separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13193prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13194
13195Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13196variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13197string formats ("Q").
13198
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013199If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013200as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013201less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13202the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13203
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013204Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013205In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013206in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013207
13208Flags are :
13209 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013210 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013211
13212 Example:
13213
13214 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13215 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13216
13217At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13218
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013219 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13220 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013221
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013222the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013223
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013224 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013225 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013226 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013227
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013228and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13229
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013230 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013231 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13232
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013233Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13234
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013235 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013236 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013237 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13238 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13239 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013240 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13241 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13242 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013243 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013244 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13245 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13246 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13247 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013248 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013249 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013250 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013251 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013252 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013253 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13254 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013255 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013256 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13257 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013258 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013259 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13260 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013261 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13262 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13263 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013264 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013265 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13266 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013267 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013268 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13269 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13270 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013271 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013272 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013273 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13274 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13275 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13276 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013277 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013278 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013279 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013280 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013281 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013282 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013283 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13284 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13285 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013286 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013287 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13288 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013289 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013290 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013291 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013292 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013293
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013294 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013295
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013296
132978.2.5. Error log format
13298-----------------------
13299
13300When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13301protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13302By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13303"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13304will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13305logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13306
13307The format looks like this :
13308
13309 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13310 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13311 Connection error during SSL handshake
13312
13313 Field Format Extract from the example above
13314 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13315 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13316 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13317 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13318 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13319
13320These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13321failures.
13322
13323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133248.3. Advanced logging options
13325-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013326
13327Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13328just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13329options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13330for more information about their usage.
13331
13332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133338.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13334------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013335
13336It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13337haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13338commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13339monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13340ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13341
13342 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13343 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13344 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13345 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13346
13347 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13348 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13349 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013350 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013351 such as other load-balancers.
13352
13353 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13354 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13355 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13356
13357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133588.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13359----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013360
13361The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13362what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13363or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13364"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13365just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13366log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13367after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13368is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13369with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13370with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13371
13372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133738.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13374------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013375
13376Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13377for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13378"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13379retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13380raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13381a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13382file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13383you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13384"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13385
13386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13388--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013389
13390Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13391multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13392them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13393"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13394logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13395error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13396and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13397too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13398useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13399alternative.
13400
13401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134028.4. Timing events
13403------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013404
13405Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13406reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13407the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13408frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13409mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13410
13411 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13412 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13413 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13414 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13415 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13416
13417 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13418 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13419 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13420 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13421 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13422
13423 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13424 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13425 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13426 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13427 connection never established.
13428
13429 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13430 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13431 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13432 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13433 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13434 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13435 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13436 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13437 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13438 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13439 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13440
13441 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13442 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13443 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13444 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013445 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013446
13447 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13448
13449 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13450 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13451 negative.
13452
13453These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13454protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13455that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013456due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013457close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13458session has been aborted on timeout.
13459
13460Most common cases :
13461
13462 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13463 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13464 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13465 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13466 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13467 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13468 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13469 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13470 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013471 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13472 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13473 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013474
13475 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13476 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13477 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13478 of ms on remote networks.
13479
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013480 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13481 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13482 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013483
13484 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13485 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13486 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13487 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13488 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13489 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13490 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13491 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13492 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13493 to the server until another one is released.
13494
13495Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13496
13497 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13498 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13499 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13500
13501 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13502 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13503 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13504
13505 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13506 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13507 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13508 flags.
13509
13510 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13511 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13512 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13513 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13514 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13515 the client connection was maintained open.
13516
13517 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013518 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013519 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13520 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13521
13522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135238.5. Session state at disconnection
13524-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013525
13526TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13527"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
135282-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13529each of which has a special meaning :
13530
13531 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13532 session to terminate :
13533
13534 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13535
13536 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13537 server explicitly refused it.
13538
13539 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13540 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13541 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13542 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013543 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13544
13545 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13546 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013547
13548 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13549 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13550 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13551 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13552 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13553
13554 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13555 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13556 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13557 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13558 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13559
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013560 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13561 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13562
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013563 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13564 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13565 backup connections when going up.
13566
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013567 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013569 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13570 send or receive data.
13571
13572 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13573 send or receive data.
13574
13575 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13576 with nothing left in the buffers.
13577
13578 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13579
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013580 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013581 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13582
13583 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13584 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13585 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13586 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13587 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13588
13589 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13590 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13591
13592 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13593 server (HTTP only).
13594
13595 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13596
13597 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13598 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13599 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13600
13601 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13602 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13603 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13604
13605 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13606
13607 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13608 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13609
13610 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13611 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13612 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13613
13614 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13615 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013616 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13617 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013618
13619 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13620 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13621 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13622 another server.
13623
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013624 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013625 server.
13626
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013627 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13628 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13629 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13630 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13631
13632 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13633 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13634 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13635 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13636
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013637 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13638 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13639 "use-server" rule).
13640
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013641 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13642
13643 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13644 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13645
13646 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13647
13648 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13649 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13650 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13651
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013652 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13653 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013654 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013655 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13656 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013658 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13659
13660 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13661 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13662
13663 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13664
13665 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13666
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013667The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13668was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013669helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13670starvation, attacks, etc...
13671
13672The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13673alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13674easier finding and understanding.
13675
13676 Flags Reason
13677
13678 -- Normal termination.
13679
13680 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13681 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13682 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13683 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13684
13685 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13686 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13687 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13688 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13689 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13690 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013692 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13693 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013694 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013695
13696 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13697 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13698 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13699
13700 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13701 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13702 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13703 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13704 the server takes too long to respond.
13705
13706 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13707 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13708 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13709 long a time to respond.
13710
13711 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13712 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13713 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13714 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013715 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13716 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013717
13718 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13719 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13720 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13721 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13722 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013723 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013724 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13725 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13726 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13727 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13728 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13729 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13730 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13731 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13732 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
13733 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
13734 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
13735 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013736
13737 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13738 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013739 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13740 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13741 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13742 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013743
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013744 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13745 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013747 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013748 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13749 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13750 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13751 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13752 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13753
13754 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13755 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13756 503 or 504 here.
13757
13758 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13759 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13760 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13761 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13762 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13763
13764 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13765 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013766 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013767 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13768 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13769
13770 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13771 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13772 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13773 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13774 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13775 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13776 between haproxy and the server.
13777
13778 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13779 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13780 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13781 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13782 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13783 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13784 solution is to fix the application.
13785
13786 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13787 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13788 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13789 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13790 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13791 external attacks.
13792
13793 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13794 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013795 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013796 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13797 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13798
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013799 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13800 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13801 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013802 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13803 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013804
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013805 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13806 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13807 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13808 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013809 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13810 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13811 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13812 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13813 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013814
13815 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13816 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13817 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13818 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13819
13820 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13821 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13822 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13823 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13824
13825 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13826 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13827 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13828 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13829
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013830The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13831persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13832important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13833re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13834
13835 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13836
13837 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13838 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13839 set on a GET request.
13840
13841 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13842 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013843 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013844 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13845
13846 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13847 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13848 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13849
13850 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13851 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13852 already got a cookie.
13853
13854 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13855 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13856 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13857 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13858 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13859
13860 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13861 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13862 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13863
13864 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13865 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13866 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13867
13868 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13869 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13870
13871 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13872 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13873 then advertised in the response.
13874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138768.6. Non-printable characters
13877-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013878
13879In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13880consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13881converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13882prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13883being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13884escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13885is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13886'}' when logging headers.
13887
13888Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13889issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13890containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13891
13892Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13893the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13894performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13895
13896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138978.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13898---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013899
13900Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13901achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013902section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013903cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13904the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13905the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013906locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013907not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13908user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13909a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13910wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13911
13912 Examples :
13913 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13914 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13915
13916 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13917 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13918
13919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139208.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13921---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013922
13923Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13924proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13925the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13926server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13927
13928Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13929response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013930section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013931
13932It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013933time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13934appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013935are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13936and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13937follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13938request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13939in the logs.
13940
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013941As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13942frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13943an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13944
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013945 Example :
13946 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13947 listen proxy-out
13948 mode http
13949 option httplog
13950 option logasap
13951 log global
13952 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13953
13954 # log the name of the virtual server
13955 capture request header Host len 20
13956
13957 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13958 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13959
13960 # log the beginning of the referrer
13961 capture request header Referer len 20
13962
13963 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13964 capture response header Server len 20
13965
13966 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13967 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13968
13969 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13970 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13971
13972 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13973 capture response header Via len 20
13974
13975 # log the URL location during a redirection
13976 capture response header Location len 20
13977
13978 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13979 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13980 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13981 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13982 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13983
13984 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13985 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13986 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13987 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013988 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013989
13990 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13991 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13992 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13993 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13994 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013995 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013996
13997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139988.9. Examples of logs
13999---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014000
14001These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14002them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14003reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14004
14005 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14006 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14007 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14008
14009 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14010 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14011
14012 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14013 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14014 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14015
14016 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14017 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14018
14019 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14020 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14021 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14022
14023 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014024 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014025 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14026 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14027
14028 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14029 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14030 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14031
14032 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14033 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014034 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014035 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14036 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14037 to return the 502 and not the server.
14038
14039 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014040 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014041
14042 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14043 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14044 Nothing was sent to any server.
14045
14046 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14047 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14048
14049 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14050 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14051 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14052 send a 408 return code to the client.
14053
14054 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14055 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14056
14057 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14058 5 seconds ("c----").
14059
14060 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14061 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014062 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014063
14064 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014065 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014066 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14067 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14068 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14069 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14070 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014071
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140739. Statistics and monitoring
14074----------------------------
14075
14076It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14077mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14078CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14079Unix socket.
14080
14081
140829.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014083---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014084
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014085The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014086page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14087begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14088represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14089use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14090('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14091(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14092text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14093do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14094use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014095
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014096In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14097that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14098S (Servers).
14099
14100 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14101 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14102 any name for server/listener)
14103 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14104 number queued without a server assigned.
14105 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14106 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14107 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14108 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14109 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14110 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14111 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14112 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14113 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14114 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14115 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14116 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14117 "option checkcache".
14118 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14119 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14120 - read error from the client
14121 - client timeout
14122 - client closed connection
14123 - various bad requests from the client.
14124 - request was tarpitted.
14125 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14126 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14127 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14128 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14129 active servers).
14130 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14131 Some other errors are:
14132 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14133 - failure applying filters to the response.
14134 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14135 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14136 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14137 switched away from.
14138 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14139 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14140 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14141 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14142 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14143 the server is up.)
14144 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14145 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14146 counters for each server.
14147 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14148 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14149 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14150 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14151 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14152 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14153 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14154 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14155 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14156 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14157 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14158 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14159 of times that server was selected.
14160 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14161 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14162 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14163 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14164 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14165 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014166 UNK -> unknown
14167 INI -> initializing
14168 SOCKERR -> socket error
14169 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014170 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014171 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14172 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14173 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14174 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14175 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14176 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14177 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14178 disable-on-404
14179 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14180 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14181 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014182 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14183 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14184 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14185 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14186 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14187 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14188 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14189 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14190 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14191 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14192 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14193 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14194 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14195 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14196 (inc. in eresp)
14197 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14198 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14199 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14200 (CPU/BW limit)
14201 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14202 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14203 server/backend
14204 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14205 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14206 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14207 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14208 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14209 (0 for TCP)
14210 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14211 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014212
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142149.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014215-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014216
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014217The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14218necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14219A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14220issuing commands by hand :
14221
14222 global
14223 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14224 stats timeout 2m
14225
14226It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14227the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14228never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14229situations :
14230
14231 global
14232 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14233 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14234 stats timeout 2m
14235
14236To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14237swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14238to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14239syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14240
14241 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14242 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14243
14244The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14245script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14246for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14247
14248The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14249that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14250editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14251(eg: watch a counter).
14252
14253The socket supports two operation modes :
14254 - interactive
14255 - non-interactive
14256
14257The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14258this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14259sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14260mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14261commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14262example :
14263
14264 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14265
14266The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14267entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14268for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14269sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14270"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14271after processing the last command of the same line.
14272
14273For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14274"prompt" command :
14275
14276 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14277 prompt
14278 > show info
14279 ...
14280 >
14281
14282Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14283delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14284that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14285parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014286
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014287It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14288on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14289own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014290
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014291The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14292If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14293all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14294it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14295
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014296add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014297 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14298 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14299 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14300 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014301
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014302add map <map> <key> <value>
14303 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14304 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014305 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14306 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14307 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014308
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014309clear counters
14310 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14311 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14312 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14313 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14314 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14315
14316clear counters all
14317 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14318 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14319 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14320
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014321clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014322 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14323 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14324 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014325
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014326clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014327 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14328 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14329 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014330
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014331clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14332 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14333
14334 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14335 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14336 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14337 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14338 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14339 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14340
14341 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14342
14343 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14344 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14345 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14346 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14347 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14348 the ACLs :
14349
14350 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14351 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14352 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14353 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14354 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14355 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14356
14357 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014358 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14359 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014360
14361 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014362 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014363 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014364 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14365 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14366 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14367 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014368
14369 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14370
14371 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014372 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014373 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14374 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014375 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14376 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14377 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014378
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014379del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14380 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014381 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14382 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14383 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14384 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014385
14386del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014387 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014388 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14389 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14390 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14391 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014392
14393disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014394 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14395
14396 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14397 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14398 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14399 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14400 re-enabled using enable agent.
14401
14402 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14403 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14404 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14405 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14406 otherwise unchanged.
14407
14408 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14409 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14410 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14411
14412 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14413 level "admin".
14414
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014415disable frontend <frontend>
14416 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14417 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14418 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14419 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14420 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14421 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14422 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14423 on the stats page.
14424
14425 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14426 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14427
14428 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14429 level "admin".
14430
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014431disable health <backend>/<server>
14432 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14433 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14434 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14435 agent check forces it down.
14436
14437 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14438 level "admin".
14439
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014440disable server <backend>/<server>
14441 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14442 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14443 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14444 during the maintenance.
14445
14446 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14447 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14448
14449 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014450 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014451
14452 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14453 level "admin".
14454
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014455enable agent <backend>/<server>
14456 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14457
14458 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14459 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14460
14461 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14462 level "admin".
14463
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014464enable frontend <frontend>
14465 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14466 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14467 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14468 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14469 which was disabled.
14470
14471 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14472 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14473
14474 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14475 level "admin".
14476
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014477enable health <backend>/<server>
14478 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14479 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14480
14481 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14482 level "admin".
14483
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014484enable server <backend>/<server>
14485 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14486 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14487
14488 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014489 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014490
14491 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14492 level "admin".
14493
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014494get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014495get acl <acl> <value>
14496 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14497 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14498 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14499 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14500 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014501
14502 The first two words are:
14503
14504 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14505 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14506 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14507
14508 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14509
14510 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14511
14512 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14513
14514 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14515 interpretation of the case.
14516
14517 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14518 useful with regular expressions.
14519
14520 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14521 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14522
14523 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14524 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14525 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14526
14527 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14528
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014529get weight <backend>/<server>
14530 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14531 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14532 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14533 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14534 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014535 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014536
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014537help
14538 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14539 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014540
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014541prompt
14542 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14543 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14544 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14545 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14546 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14547 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14548 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14549 command.
14550
14551quit
14552 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014553
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014554set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014555 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14556 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14557 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014558
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014559set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014560 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14561 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14562 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14563 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14564 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014565 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14566 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14567
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014568set maxconn global <maxconn>
14569 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14570 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14571 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14572 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14573 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14574 setting.
14575
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014576set rate-limit connections global <value>
14577 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14578 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14579 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14580 is passed in number of connections per second.
14581
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014582set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14583 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14584 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014585 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14586 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014587
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014588set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14589 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14590 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14591 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14592 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14593
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014594set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14595 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14596 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14597 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14598 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14599 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14600
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014601set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14602 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14603 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14604 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14605
14606set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14607 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14608 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14609 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14610
14611set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14612 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14613 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14614 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14615 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14616 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14617 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14618 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14619 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14620
14621set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14622 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14623 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14624
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014625set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14626 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14627 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14628 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14629 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14630
14631 Example:
14632 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14633 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14634 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14635 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14636
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014637set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014638 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14639 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14640 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14641 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014642 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14643 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014645set timeout cli <delay>
14646 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14647 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14648 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14649
14650set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14651 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14652 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014653 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14654 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14655 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14656 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14657 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14658 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14659 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14660 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14661 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14662 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14663 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14664 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14665 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014666
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014667show errors [<iid>]
14668 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14669 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014670 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14671 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14672 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014673
14674 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14675 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14676 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14677 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14678 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14679 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14680 are reported too.
14681
14682 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14683 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14684 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14685 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14686 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14687 code.
14688
14689 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14690 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14691 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14692 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14693 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14694 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14695 line.
14696
14697 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014698 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14699 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014700 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14701 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14702
14703 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14704 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14705 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14706 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14707 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14708 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14709 00204+ minal\r\n
14710 00211 \r\n
14711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014712 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014713 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14714 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14715 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14716 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14717 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14718 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014719
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014720show info
14721 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14722
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014723show map [<map>]
14724 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014725 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14726 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14727 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14728 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14729 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14730 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014731
14732show acl [<acl>]
14733 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014734 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14735 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14736 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14737 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14738 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014739
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014740show pools
14741 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14742 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14743 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14744 the pools.
14745
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014746show sess
14747 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014748 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14749 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14750
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014751show sess <id>
14752 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14753 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14754 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14755 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14756 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014757 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14758 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14759
14760 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14761 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014762
14763show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14764 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14765 possible to dump only selected items :
14766 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14767 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14768 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14769 for example:
14770 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14771 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14772 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14773
14774 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014775 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14776 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014777 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14778 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14779 Nbproc: 1
14780 Process_num: 1
14781 (...)
14782
14783 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14784 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14785 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14786 (...)
14787 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14788
14789 $
14790
14791 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14792 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14793 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14794 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014795 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014796
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014797show table
14798 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14799 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14800 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14801 entries currently in use.
14802
14803 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014804 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014805 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14806 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014807
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014808show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014809 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14810 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14811 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014812 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14813
14814 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14815 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14816 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14817 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14818 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14819
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014820 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14821 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14822 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14823 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14824 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14825 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14826
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014827
14828 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014829 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14830 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014831
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014832 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014833 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014834 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014835 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14836 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14837 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14838 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014839
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014840 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014841 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014842 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14843 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014844
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014845 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14846 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014847 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014848 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14849 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014850
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014851 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14852 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014853 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014854 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14855 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14856
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014857 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14858 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14859 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14860 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14861 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14862
14863 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14864 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14865 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014866 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14867 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014868 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14869 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014870
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014871shutdown frontend <frontend>
14872 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14873 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14874 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14875 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14876 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14877 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14878 once it is terminated.
14879
14880 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14881 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14882
14883 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14884 level "admin".
14885
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014886shutdown session <id>
14887 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14888 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14889 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14890 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14891 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14892 flag in the logs.
14893
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014894shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014895 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14896 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14897 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14898 'K' flag in the logs.
14899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014900/*
14901 * Local variables:
14902 * fill-column: 79
14903 * End:
14904 */